blob: f5cf60305a575a5164d6cedf0d2791ded7fa353d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf08137c2017-10-22 10:13:45 +02007 2017/10/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000593 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000594 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200595 - tune.buffers.limit
596 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200597 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200598 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100599 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100600 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200601 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200602 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100603 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100605 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100606 - tune.lua.session-timeout
607 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200608 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100609 - tune.maxaccept
610 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200611 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200612 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200613 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.rcvbuf.client
615 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100616 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100617 - tune.sndbuf.client
618 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100619 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200621 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100622 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200623 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200624 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100625 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100627 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200628 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
629 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
630 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100631 - tune.zlib.memlevel
632 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 * Debugging
635 - debug
636 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637
638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006393.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640------------------------------------
641
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642ca-base <dir>
643 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200644 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
645 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647chroot <jail dir>
648 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
649 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
650 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
651 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
652 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
653 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100654
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
656 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
657 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
658 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100659 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
660 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
661 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
662 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
663 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
664 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
665 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
666 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
667 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
668 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100669
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200670crt-base <dir>
671 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
672 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
673 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675daemon
676 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
677 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
678 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
679
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200680deviceatlas-json-file <path>
681 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
682 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
683
684deviceatlas-log-level <value>
685 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
686 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
687
688deviceatlas-separator <char>
689 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
690 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
691
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100692deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200693 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
694 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
695 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100696
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900697external-check
698 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
699 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
700 See "option external-check".
701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702gid <number>
703 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
704 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
705 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100706 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
707 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100710hard-stop-after <time>
711 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
712
713 Arguments :
714 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
715 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
716 SIGUSR1 signal.
717
718 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
719 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
720 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
721
722 Example:
723 global
724 hard-stop-after 30s
725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726group <group name>
727 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
728 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200730log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
732 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100733 configured with "log global".
734
735 <address> can be one of:
736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100737 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100738 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
739 port).
740
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100741 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
742 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
743 port).
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
746 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
747 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
748 writeable).
749
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
751 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100752
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200753 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
754 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
755 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
756 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
757 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
758 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
759 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
760 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
761 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
762 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200763 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
764 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200765
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200766 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
767 one of the following :
768
769 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
771
772 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
773 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
774
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100775 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
777 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
778 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
779 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
780
781 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200782 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
783 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
784 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
785 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
786 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
787 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200789 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100791log-send-hostname [<string>]
792 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
793 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
794 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
795 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
796 the logs.
797
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000798log-tag <string>
799 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
800 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
801 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100802 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000803
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100804lua-load <file>
805 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
806 used multiple times.
807
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200808master-worker [exit-on-failure]
809 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
810 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
811 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
812 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
813 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
814 systemd.
815 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
816 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
817 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
818 the whole process.
819
820 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822nbproc <number>
823 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
824 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
825 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
826 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
827 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
828
829pidfile <pidfile>
830 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
831 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
832 starting the process. See also "daemon".
833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834presetenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
837 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
840resetenv [<name> ...]
841 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
842 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
843 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
844 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
845 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
846 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
847 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
848 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
849
Olivier Houchard9679ac92017-10-27 14:58:08 +0200850ssl-allow-0rtt
851 Allow using 0RTT on every listener. 0RTT is prone to various attacks, so be
852 sure to know the security implications before activating it.
853
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100854stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200855 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
856 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
857 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
858 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
859 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
860 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100861 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200862 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
863 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200864
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200865server-state-base <directory>
866 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200867 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
868 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200869
870server-state-file <file>
871 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
872 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
873 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
874 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
875 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
876 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
877 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
878 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200879 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
880 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200881
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100882setenv <name> <value>
883 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
884 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
885 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
886 and "unsetenv".
887
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
890 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300891 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100892 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
893 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
894 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
895 "bind" keyword for more information.
896
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100897ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
900 keyword to see available options.
901
902 Example:
903 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200904 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100905
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100906ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
908 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300909 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100910 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
911 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
912 information.
913
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100914ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
916 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
917 keyword to see available options.
918
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200919ssl-dh-param-file <file>
920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
921 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
922 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
923 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
924 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200925 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
926 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
927 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
928 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200929 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
930 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
931 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
932
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100933ssl-server-verify [none|required]
934 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
935 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
936 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
937
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200938stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
939 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
940 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
941 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200942 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200943 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200944
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200945 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
946 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
947 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200948
949stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
950 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
951 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100952 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200953
954stats maxconn <connections>
955 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
956 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
957
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958uid <number>
959 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
960 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
961 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
962 one. See also "gid" and "user".
963
964ulimit-n <number>
965 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
966 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
967 option.
968
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100969unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
970 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
971
972 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
973 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
974 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
975 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
976 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
977 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
978 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
979 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
980 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
981 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
982
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100983unsetenv [<name> ...]
984 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
985 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
986 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
987 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
988 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
989 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
990 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992user <user name>
993 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
994 See also "uid" and "group".
995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200996node <name>
997 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
998
999 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1000 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1001 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1002 traffic.
1003
1004description <text>
1005 Add a text that describes the instance.
1006
1007 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1008 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1009 "<" and ">" characters.
1010
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100101151degrees-data-file <file path>
1012 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1013 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1014
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001015 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001016 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1017
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000101851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001019 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1020 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1021 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1022
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001024 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1025
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200102651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001027 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1028 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1029
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001030 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1031 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1032
103351degrees-cache-size <number>
1034 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1035 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1036 By default, this cache is disabled.
1037
1038 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1040
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001041wurfl-data-file <file path>
1042 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1043 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1044
1045 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1046 with USE_WURFL=1.
1047
1048wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1049 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1050 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1051 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1052
1053 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1054
1055 Valid WURFL properties are:
1056 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1057
1058 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1059 device.
1060
1061 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1062 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1063
1064 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1065 particular web request.
1066
1067 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1068 used Libwurfl API version.
1069
1070 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1071 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1072 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1073
1074 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1075 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1076
1077 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1078 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1079
1080 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1081
1082 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1083
1084 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1085 with USE_WURFL=1.
1086
1087wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1088 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1089 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1090
1091 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1092 with USE_WURFL=1.
1093
1094wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1095 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1096 thus before the chroot.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1102 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1103 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1104 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1105 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1106 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1107 mode is enabled by default.
1108
1109 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1110 with USE_WURFL=1.
1111
1112wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1113 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1114 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1115 - "0" : no cache is used.
1116 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1117 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1118 the highest performing option.
1119
1120 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1121 with USE_WURFL=1.
1122
1123wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1124 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1125 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1126
1127 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1128 with USE_WURFL=1.
1129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011313.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132-----------------------
1133
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001134max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1135 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1136 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1137 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1138 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1139 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1140 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1141 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1142 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144maxconn <number>
1145 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1146 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1147 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001148 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1149 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1150 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1151 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001152 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1153 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1154 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1155 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1156 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001158maxconnrate <number>
1159 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1160 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1161 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1162 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1163 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1164 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1165 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1166 fairness.
1167
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001168maxcomprate <number>
1169 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001170 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001171 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1172 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1173 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1174 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1175 default value.
1176
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001177maxcompcpuusage <number>
1178 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1179 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1180 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1181 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1182 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1183 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1184 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1185 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1186
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001187maxpipes <number>
1188 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1189 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1190 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1191 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1192 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1193 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1194
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001195maxsessrate <number>
1196 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1197 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1198 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1199 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1200 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1201 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1202 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1203 fairness.
1204
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001205maxsslconn <number>
1206 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1207 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1208 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1209 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1210 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1211 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1212 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001213 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1214 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1215 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1216 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1217 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1218 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1219 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001220
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001221maxsslrate <number>
1222 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1223 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1224 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1225 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1226 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1227 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1228 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1229 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1230 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1231 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1232
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001233maxzlibmem <number>
1234 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1235 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1236 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001237 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1238 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1239 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241noepoll
1242 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1243 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001244 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
1246nokqueue
1247 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1248 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1249 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1250
1251nopoll
1252 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1253 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001255 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001257nosplice
1258 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1259 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1260 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001261 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001262 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1263 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1264 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1265 "option splice-response".
1266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267nogetaddrinfo
1268 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1269 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1270
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001271noreuseport
1272 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1273 command line argument "-dR".
1274
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001275spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001276 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1277 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1278 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1279 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1280 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1281 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001282
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001283ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1284 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1285 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1286 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1287 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1288 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1289 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1290 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1291 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1292 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1293 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1294 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1295 openssl configuration file uses:
1296 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1297
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001298ssl-mode-async
1299 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001300 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001301 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1302 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1303 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1304 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1305 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001306
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001307tune.buffers.limit <number>
1308 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1309 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1310 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1311 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1312 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1313 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1314 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1315 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1316 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1317 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1318 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1319 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1320 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1321 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1322 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1323
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001324tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1325 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1326 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1327 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1328 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1329
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001330tune.bufsize <number>
1331 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1332 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1333 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1334 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1335 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1336 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1337 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1338 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001339 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1340 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1341 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001342
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001343tune.chksize <number>
1344 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1345 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1346 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1347 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1348 checks whenever possible.
1349
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001350tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1351 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1352 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1353 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1354 this value. The default value is 1.
1355
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001356tune.http.cookielen <number>
1357 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1358 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1359 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1360 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1361 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1362 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1363 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1364 to change this value.
1365
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001366tune.http.logurilen <number>
1367 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1368 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1369 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1370 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1371 configuration directives too.
1372 The default value is 1024.
1373
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001374tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1375 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1376 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1377 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1378 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1379 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1380 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001381 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1382 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1383 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001384
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001385tune.idletimer <timeout>
1386 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1387 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1388 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1389 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1390 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1391 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1392 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1393 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1394 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1395
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001396tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1397 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001398 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001399 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1400 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1401 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1402 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1403 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1404
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001405tune.lua.maxmem
1406 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1407 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1408 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1409 memory.
1410
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001411tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1412 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001413 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1414 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1415 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001416
1417tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1418 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1419 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1420 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1421 check servers.
1422
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001423tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1424 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1425 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1426 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1427 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1428
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001429tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001430 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1431 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1432 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1433 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1434 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1435 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1436 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1437 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1438 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1439 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001440
1441tune.maxpollevents <number>
1442 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1443 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1444 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1445 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1446 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1447
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001448tune.maxrewrite <number>
1449 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1450 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1451 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1452 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1453 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1454 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1455 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1456 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1457 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1458 bufsize.
1459
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001460tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1461 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1462 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1463 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1464 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1465 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1466 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1467 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1468 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1469 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1470 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1471 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1472 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1473 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1474 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1475 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1476 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1477 setting this parameter to 0.
1478
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001479tune.pipesize <number>
1480 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1481 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1482 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1483 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1484 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1485 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1486
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001487tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1488tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1489 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1490 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1491 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1492 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1493 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1494 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1495 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1496
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001497tune.recv_enough <number>
1498 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1499 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1500 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1501 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1502 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1503
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001504tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1505tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1506 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1507 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1508 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1509 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1510 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1511 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1512 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1513 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1514 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1515 notifying haproxy again.
1516
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001517tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001518 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1519 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1520 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001521 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001522 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1523 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1524 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1525 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1526 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001527 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1528 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001529
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001530tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1531 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1532 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1533 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1534 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1535 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1536 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1537
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001538tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1539 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001540 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001541 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1542 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1543 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1544 being used for too long.
1545
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001546tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1547 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1548 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1549 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1550 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1551 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1552 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1553 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1554 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1555 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1556 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001557 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1558 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001559
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001560tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1561 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1562 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1563 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1564 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1565 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1566 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1567 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001568 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1569 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001570
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001571tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1572 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1573 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1574 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1575 1000 entries.
1576
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001577tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1578 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1579 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1580 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1581
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001582tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001583tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001584tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1585tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1586tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001587 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1588 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1589 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1590 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1591 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1592 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1593 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1594 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001595
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001596 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1597 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1598 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1599 all available space is consumed.
1600 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1601 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1602 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001603
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001604tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1605 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001606 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001607 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1608 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1609 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1610
1611tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1612 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1613 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1614 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1615 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016173.3. Debugging
1618--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001619
1620debug
1621 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1622 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1623 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1624 system startup.
1625
1626quiet
1627 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1628 line argument "-q".
1629
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016313.4. Userlists
1632--------------
1633It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1634http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1635it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1636
1637userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001638 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001639 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1640
1641group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001642 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001643 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1644 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1645
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001646user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1647 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001648 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1649 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001650 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1651 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001652 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001653 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001654
1655
1656 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001657 userlist L1
1658 group G1 users tiger,scott
1659 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001660
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001661 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1662 user scott insecure-password elgato
1663 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001664
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001665 userlist L2
1666 group G1
1667 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001668
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001669 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1670 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1671 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001672
1673 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001674
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001675
16763.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001677----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001678It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1679several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1680instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1681values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1682automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1683In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1684using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1685tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1686reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1687Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1688that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1689each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001690
1691peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001692 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001693 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1694
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001695disabled
1696 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1697 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1698 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1699
1700enable
1701 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1702
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001703peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1704 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1705 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1706 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1707 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1708 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1709 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1710
1711 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1712 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1713
1714 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1715 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1716 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1717 across all peers.
1718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001719 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1720 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001721
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001722 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001723 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001724 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1725 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1726 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001727
1728 backend mybackend
1729 mode tcp
1730 balance roundrobin
1731 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1732 stick on src
1733
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001734 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1735 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001736
1737
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017383.6. Mailers
1739------------
1740It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1741If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1742in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1743
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001744mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001745 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1746 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1747
1748mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1749 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1750
1751 Example:
1752 mailers mymailers
1753 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1754 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1755
1756 backend mybackend
1757 mode tcp
1758 balance roundrobin
1759
1760 email-alert mailers mymailers
1761 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1762 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1763
1764 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1765 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1766
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001767timeout mail <time>
1768 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1769 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1770 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1771 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1772
1773 Example:
1774 mailers mymailers
1775 timeout mail 20s
1776 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001779----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001781Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001782 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001783 - frontend <name>
1784 - backend <name>
1785 - listen <name>
1786
1787A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1788its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1789section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791
1792A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1793connections.
1794
1795A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1796to forward incoming connections.
1797
1798A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1799parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1802'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1803case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1804
1805Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1806logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1807proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1808However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1809name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1810
1811Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1812and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001813bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1815modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1816arbitrary criteria.
1817
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001818In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1819a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1820the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1821
1822 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1823 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1824 between responses and new requests.
1825
1826 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1827 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1828 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1829 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1830
1831 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1832 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1833 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1834
1835 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1836 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1837 client-facing connection remains open.
1838
1839 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1840 after the end of the response.
1841
1842The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1843frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1844following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1845weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1846
1847 Backend mode
1848
1849 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1850 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1851 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1852 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1853 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1854 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1855 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1856 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1857 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1858 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1859 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1860
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1864--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001866The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1867limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1868they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1869limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001871option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001872and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1873with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1874specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001876
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001877 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1878------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1879acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001880appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881backlog X X X -
1882balance X - X X
1883bind - X X -
1884bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001885block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886capture cookie - X X -
1887capture request header - X X -
1888capture response header - X X -
1889clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001890compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1892cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001893declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001894default-server X - X X
1895default_backend X X X -
1896description - X X X
1897disabled X X X X
1898dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001899email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001900email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001901email-alert mailers X X X X
1902email-alert myhostname X X X X
1903email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001904enabled X X X X
1905errorfile X X X X
1906errorloc X X X X
1907errorloc302 X X X X
1908-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1909errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001910force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001911filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912fullconn X - X X
1913grace X X X X
1914hash-type X - X X
1915http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001916http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001917http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001918http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001919http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001920http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001921http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001922id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001923ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001924load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001925log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001926log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001927log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001928log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001929max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001930maxconn X X X -
1931mode X X X X
1932monitor fail - X X -
1933monitor-net X X X -
1934monitor-uri X X X -
1935option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1936option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1937option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1938option allbackups (*) X - X X
1939option checkcache (*) X - X X
1940option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1941option contstats (*) X X X -
1942option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1943option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1944option forceclose (*) X X X X
1945-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1946option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001947option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001948option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001949option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001950option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001951option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001952option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001953option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1955option httpchk X - X X
1956option httpclose (*) X X X X
1957option httplog X X X X
1958option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001959option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001960option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001961option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001962option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1963option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1964option logasap (*) X X X -
1965option mysql-check X - X X
1966option nolinger (*) X X X X
1967option originalto X X X X
1968option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001969option pgsql-check X - X X
1970option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001972option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001973option smtpchk X - X X
1974option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1975option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1976option splice-request (*) X X X X
1977option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001978option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1980option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1981-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001982option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001983option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1984option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1985option tcpka X X X X
1986option tcplog X X X X
1987option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001988external-check command X - X X
1989external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001990persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1991rate-limit sessions X X X -
1992redirect - X X X
1993redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1994redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1995reqadd - X X X
1996reqallow - X X X
1997reqdel - X X X
1998reqdeny - X X X
1999reqiallow - X X X
2000reqidel - X X X
2001reqideny - X X X
2002reqipass - X X X
2003reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002004reqitarpit - X X X
2005reqpass - X X X
2006reqrep - X X X
2007-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002008reqtarpit - X X X
2009retries X - X X
2010rspadd - X X X
2011rspdel - X X X
2012rspdeny - X X X
2013rspidel - X X X
2014rspideny - X X X
2015rspirep - X X X
2016rsprep - X X X
2017server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002018server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002019server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002020source X - X X
2021srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002022stats admin - X X X
2023stats auth X X X X
2024stats enable X X X X
2025stats hide-version X X X X
2026stats http-request - X X X
2027stats realm X X X X
2028stats refresh X X X X
2029stats scope X X X X
2030stats show-desc X X X X
2031stats show-legends X X X X
2032stats show-node X X X X
2033stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002034-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2035stick match - - X X
2036stick on - - X X
2037stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002038stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002039stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002040tcp-check connect - - X X
2041tcp-check expect - - X X
2042tcp-check send - - X X
2043tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002044tcp-request connection - X X -
2045tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002046tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002047tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002048tcp-response content - - X X
2049tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002050timeout check X - X X
2051timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002052timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2054timeout connect X - X X
2055timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2056timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2057timeout http-request X X X X
2058timeout queue X - X X
2059timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002060timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002061timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2062timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002063timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002064transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002065unique-id-format X X X -
2066unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002067use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002068use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002069------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2070 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020734.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2074---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075
2076This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2077
2078
2079acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2080 Declare or complete an access list.
2081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2082 no | yes | yes | yes
2083 Example:
2084 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2085 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2086 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002088 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
2090
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002091appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2092 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 no | no | yes | yes
2096 Arguments :
2097 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2098 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2099
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002100 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 checked in each cookie value.
2102
2103 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2104 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2105 milliseconds.
2106
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002107 request-learn
2108 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2109 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2110 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2111 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2112 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2113 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2114
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002115 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2116 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2117 data following this prefix.
2118
2119 Example :
2120 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2121
2122 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2123 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2124
2125 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2126 2 modes are currently supported :
2127 - path-parameters :
2128 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2129 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2130 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2131 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2132 - query-string :
2133 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2134 query string.
2135
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002136 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2137 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2138 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002140 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2141 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142
2143
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002144backlog <conns>
2145 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2147 yes | yes | yes | no
2148 Arguments :
2149 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2150 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002152
2153 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2154 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2155 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2156 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2157 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2158 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2159 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2160 backlog parameter.
2161
2162 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2163 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2164 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2165
2166 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2167
2168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002170balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 yes | no | yes | yes
2174 Arguments :
2175 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2176 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2177 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2178 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2179
2180 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2181 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2182 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2183 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002184 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002185 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002186 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2187 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2188 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2189 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2190 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2191 it, so that you don't worry.
2192
2193 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2194 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2195 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2196 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2197 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2198 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2199 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2200 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002202 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2203 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2204 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2205 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2206 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2207 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2208 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2209 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2210
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002211 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002212 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002213 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2214 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002215 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002216 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2217 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2218 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2219 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2220 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002221 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2222 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2223 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2224 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2225 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2226 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002227
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2229 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2230 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2231 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2232 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2233 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2234 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2235 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002236 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002238 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2239 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2240 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002242 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2243 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2244 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2245 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2246 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2247 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2248 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2249 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2250 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2251 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2252 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2253 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002255 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002256 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2257 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2258 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2259 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2260 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2261 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2262 URIs start with a leading "/".
2263
2264 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2265 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2266 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2267 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002270 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2271
2272 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002273 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2274 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002275 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2276 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2277 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2278 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002279 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002280 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2281 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282
2283 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2284 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2285 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2286 server will receive the request.
2287
2288 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2289 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2290 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2291 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2292 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002293 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2294 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2295 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002297 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2298 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2299 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2300 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2301 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002303 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002304 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2305 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2306 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2307
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002308 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2309 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2310 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2311
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002312 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002313 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002314 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2315 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2316 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2317 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2318 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2319 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002320 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002321 used instead.
2322
2323 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2324 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2325 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2326 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2327
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002328 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2329 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2330 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2331
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002332 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002335 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2336 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002337
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002338 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2339 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2340 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
2342 Examples :
2343 balance roundrobin
2344 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002345 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002346 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2347 balance hdr(host)
2348 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002349
2350 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2351 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002353 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002354 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2355 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2356 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2357 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2358
2359 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2360 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2361 defaults to 16 kB.
2362
2363 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2364 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2365
2366 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2367 Round Robin.
2368
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002369 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002370 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2371 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2372 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2373
2374 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2375
2376 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002377 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002378 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2379 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2380 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002382 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
2384
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002385bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2386bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2389 no | yes | yes | no
2390 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002391 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2392 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2393 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2394 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002395 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002396 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2397 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2398 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2399 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2400 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2401 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2402 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002403 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2404 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2405 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2406 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2407 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2408 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2409 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002410 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2411 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2412 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002413 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2414 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2415 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002416
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002417 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2418 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002419 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2420 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2421 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002422 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2423 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2424 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2425 the range.
2426
2427 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2428 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2429 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2430 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2431 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2432 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2433 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002434 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002435 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002437 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2438 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2439 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2440 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2441 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2442 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2443 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2444 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002446 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2447 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2448 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2449 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2452 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2453 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2454 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2455 in a frontend.
2456
2457 Example :
2458 listen http_proxy
2459 bind :80,:443
2460 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002461 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002463 listen http_https_proxy
2464 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002465 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002466
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002467 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2468 bind ipv6@:80
2469 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2470 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2471
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002472 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002474
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002475 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2476 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2477 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2478 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2479 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2480
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002481 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002482 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483
2484
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002485bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2488 yes | yes | yes | yes
2489 Arguments :
2490 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2491 may be used to override a default value.
2492
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002493 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002494 option may be combined with other numbers.
2495
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002496 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002497 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2498 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2499 missing from all processes.
2500
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002501 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002502 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002503 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2504 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2505 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2506 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002507
2508 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2509 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2510 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2511 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2512 and 'even' instances.
2513
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002514 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2515 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2516 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2517 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002518
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002519 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2520 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2521
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002522 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2523 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2524 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2525
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002526 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2527 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2528
2529 Example :
2530 listen app_ip1
2531 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002532 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002533
2534 listen app_ip2
2535 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002536 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002537
2538 listen management
2539 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002540 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002541
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002542 listen management
2543 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2544 bind-process 1-4
2545
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002546 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002547
2548
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002549block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 no | yes | yes | yes
2553
2554 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2555 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002556 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002557 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002559 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2560 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2561 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002563 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2564 "http-request deny" instead.
2565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566 Example:
2567 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2568 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2569 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002570 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2571 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2572 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002574 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2575 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2576 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577
2578capture cookie <name> len <length>
2579 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2581 no | yes | yes | no
2582 Arguments :
2583 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2584 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2585 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2586 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2587 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2588
2589 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2590 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2591 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2592 right if it exceeds <length>.
2593
2594 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2595 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2596 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2597 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2598
2599 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2600 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2601 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2602
2603 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2604 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2605 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002606 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2607 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2608 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609
2610 Example:
2611 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2612
2613 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615
2616
2617capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002618 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | no
2621 Arguments :
2622 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002623 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002624 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2625 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2626 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2627
2628 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2629 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2630 it exceeds <length>.
2631
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002632 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2634 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002635 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2636 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2637 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2638 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002639 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002640 environments to find where the request came from.
2641
2642 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2643 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2644 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2645 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002647 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2648 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2649 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2650 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2651 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652
2653 Example:
2654 capture request header Host len 15
2655 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002656 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002658 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002659 about logging.
2660
2661
2662capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002663 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2665 no | yes | yes | no
2666 Arguments :
2667 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002668 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2670 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2671 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2672
2673 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2674 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2675 it exceeds <length>.
2676
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002677 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2679 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2680 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002681 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2682 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2683 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2684 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002686 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2687 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2688 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2689 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2690 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
2692 Example:
2693 capture response header Content-length len 9
2694 capture response header Location len 15
2695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002696 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002697 about logging.
2698
2699
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002700clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2703 yes | yes | yes | no
2704 Arguments :
2705 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2707 as explained at the top of this document.
2708
2709 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2710 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2711 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2712 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2713 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2714 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2715 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2716 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002717 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2719 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2720
2721 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2722 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2723 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2724 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2725 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2726 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2727
2728 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2729 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2730
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002731 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2732 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002734compression algo <algorithm> ...
2735compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002736compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002737 Enable HTTP compression.
2738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2739 yes | yes | yes | yes
2740 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002741 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2742 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2743 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2744
2745 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002746 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2747 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2748 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002749
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002750 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002751 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002752
2753 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2754 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2755 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2756 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2757 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002758 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002759
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002760 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2761 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2762 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2763 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2764 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2765 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2766 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002767 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002768
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002769 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002770 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002771 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2772 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2773 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2774 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2775 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002776
2777 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2778 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2779 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2780 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2781 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002782 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2783 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2784 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2785 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2786 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002787 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2788 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002789
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002790 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002791 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2792 "Accept-Encoding" header
2793 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002794 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002795 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2796 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002797 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2798 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2799 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2800 "multipart"
2801 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2802 header
2803 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2804 and later
2805 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2806 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002807
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002808 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2809 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002810
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002811 Examples :
2812 compression algo gzip
2813 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002815
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002816contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 yes | no | yes | yes
2820 Arguments :
2821 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2822 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2823 as explained at the top of this document.
2824
2825 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002826 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002827 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2829 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2830 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2831 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2832
2833 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2835 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2836 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2837 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2838 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2839
2840 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2841 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2842 instead.
2843
2844 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2845 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2846
2847
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002848cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002849 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2850 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002851 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2854 yes | no | yes | yes
2855 Arguments :
2856 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2857 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2858 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2859 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2860 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2861 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2862 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2863 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2864 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2865
2866 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2867 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2868 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2869 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2870 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2871 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002872 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2873 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2874 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2875 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2876 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
2878 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002879 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002880
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002881 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002882 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2883 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2884 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2885 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2886 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2887 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2888 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2889 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2890 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2891 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002892
2893 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2894 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2895 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2896 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2897 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2898 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2899 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2900 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2901 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002902 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002903 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2904 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2905 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002907 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2908 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2909 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002910 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2911 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2912 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2913 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002914 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2915 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2916 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
2918 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2919 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2920 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2921 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2922 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2923 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2924 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2925 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2926 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2927
2928 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2929 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2930 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2931 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2932 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2933 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2934 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2935 persistence cookie in the cache.
2936 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2937
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002938 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2939 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2940 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2941 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2942 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2943 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2944 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2945 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2946 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2947 they logout.
2948
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002949 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2950 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2951 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2952 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2953
2954 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2955 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2956 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2957 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2958 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2959 this attribute.
2960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002961 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002962 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002963 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2964 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2965 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2966 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2967 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2968 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002970 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2971 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2972 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2973 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2974 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2975 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2976 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2977 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2978 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2979 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2980 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2981 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2982 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2983 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2984 the site.
2985
2986 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2987 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2988 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2989 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2990 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2991 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2992 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2993 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2994 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2995 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2996 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2997 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2998 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2999 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3000 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3001 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3002
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003003 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3004 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3005 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3006 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3007 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3008 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3011 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3012 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3013 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003015 Examples :
3016 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3017 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3018 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003019 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003020
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003021 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003023
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003024declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3025 Declares a capture slot.
3026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 no | yes | yes | no
3028 Arguments:
3029 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3030
3031 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3032 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3033 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3034 for use in the response.
3035
3036 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003037 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003038 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3039
3040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003041default-server [param*]
3042 Change default options for a server in a backend
3043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3044 yes | no | yes | yes
3045 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003046 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3047 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3048 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3049 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003050
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003051 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003052 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3053
3054 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003056
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057default_backend <backend>
3058 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3060 yes | yes | yes | no
3061 Arguments :
3062 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3063
3064 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3065 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3066 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3067 will catch all undetermined requests.
3068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069 Example :
3070
3071 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3072 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3073 default_backend dynamic
3074
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003075 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003078description <string>
3079 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 no | yes | yes | yes
3082 Arguments : string
3083
3084 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3085 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3086 it describes.
3087 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3088
3089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090disabled
3091 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 yes | yes | yes | yes
3094 Arguments : none
3095
3096 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3097 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3098 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3099 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3100 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3101 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3102 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3103
3104 See also : "enabled"
3105
3106
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003107dispatch <address>:<port>
3108 Set a default server address
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003111 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003112
3113 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3114 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3115 during start-up.
3116
3117 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3118 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3119 possible with normal servers.
3120
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003121 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003122 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3123 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3124 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3125 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3126
3127 See also : "server"
3128
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003129
3130dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3131 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3133 yes | no | yes | yes
3134 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3135
3136 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3137 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3138 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3139 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3140 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3141 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003142
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143enabled
3144 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | yes | yes | yes
3147 Arguments : none
3148
3149 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3150 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3151
3152 See also : "disabled"
3153
3154
3155errorfile <code> <file>
3156 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 yes | yes | yes | yes
3159 Arguments :
3160 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003161 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3162 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
3164 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003165 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003167 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3168 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
3170 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3171 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3172 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3173
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003174 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3175
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3177 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3178 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3179 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3180
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003181 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3182 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3183 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3184 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3185 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3186 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3189 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3190 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003191 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3193
3194 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3195
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003196 Example :
3197 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003198 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003199 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3200 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003202
3203errorloc <code> <url>
3204errorloc302 <code> <url>
3205 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | yes
3208 Arguments :
3209 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003210 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3211 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003212
3213 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3214 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3215 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3216 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3217 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3218
3219 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3220 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3221 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3222
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003223 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3226 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3227 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3228 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003229 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3231 request.
3232
3233 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3234
3235
3236errorloc303 <code> <url>
3237 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | yes | yes | yes
3240 Arguments :
3241 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003242 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3243 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003244
3245 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3246 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3247 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3248 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3249 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3250
3251 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3252 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3253 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3254
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003255 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003257 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3258 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3259 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3260 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003261 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262
3263 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3264
3265
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003266email-alert from <emailaddr>
3267 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3268 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3270 yes | yes | yes | yes
3271
3272 Arguments :
3273
3274 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3275
3276 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3277 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3278
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003279 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003280 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3281 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003282
3283
3284email-alert level <level>
3285 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3286 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 yes | yes | yes | yes
3289
3290 Arguments :
3291
3292 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3293 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3294 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3295
3296 By default level is alert
3297
3298 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3299 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3300 for the proxy.
3301
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003302 Alerts are sent when :
3303
3304 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3305 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3306 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3307 is notice or lower
3308 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3309 and a health check status update occurs
3310
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003311 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3312 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003313 section 3.6 about mailers.
3314
3315
3316email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3317 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3319 yes | yes | yes | yes
3320
3321 Arguments :
3322
3323 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3324
3325 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3326 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3327
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003328 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3329 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003330
3331
3332email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3333 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3334 mailers.
3335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | yes | yes | yes
3337
3338 Arguments :
3339
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003340 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003341
3342 By default the systems hostname is used.
3343
3344 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3345 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3346 for the proxy.
3347
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003348 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3349 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003350
3351
3352email-alert to <emailaddr>
3353 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3354 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | yes | yes | yes
3357
3358 Arguments :
3359
3360 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3361
3362 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3363 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3364
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003365 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003366 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3367
3368
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003369force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3370 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3372 no | yes | yes | yes
3373
3374 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3375 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3376 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3377 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3378 marked down for maintenance operations.
3379
3380 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3381 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3382 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3383 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3384 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3385 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3386 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3387 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3388 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3389
3390 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3391 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3392 is used.
3393
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003394 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003395 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003396
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003397
3398filter <name> [param*]
3399 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 no | yes | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
3403 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3404 referenced in section 9.
3405
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003406 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003407 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003408 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3409 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003410
3411 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3412 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3413
3414 Example:
3415 listen
3416 bind *:80
3417
3418 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3419 filter compression
3420 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3421
3422 compression algo gzip
3423 compression offload
3424
3425 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3426
3427 See also : section 9.
3428
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003429
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003430fullconn <conns>
3431 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3433 yes | no | yes | yes
3434 Arguments :
3435 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3436 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3437
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003438 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003439 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003440 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3442 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3443 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3444 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3445 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003446 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003448 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3449 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003450 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3451 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3452 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003454 Example :
3455 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3456 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3457 # connections.
3458 backend dynamic
3459 fullconn 10000
3460 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3461 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3462
3463 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3464
3465
3466grace <time>
3467 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470 Arguments :
3471 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3472 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3473 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3474
3475 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3476 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003478 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3479
3480 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3481 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3482 simplify it.
3483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003485hash-balance-factor <factor>
3486 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 yes | no | no | yes
3489 Arguments :
3490 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3491 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3492 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3493
3494 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3495 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3496 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3497 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3498 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3499 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3500 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3501
3502 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3503 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3504 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3505 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3506 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3507
3508 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3509
3510
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003511hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003512 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | no | yes | yes
3515 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003516 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3517 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003518
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003519 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3520 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3521 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3522 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3523 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3524 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3525 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3526 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3527 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3528 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003529
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003530 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3531 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3532 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3533 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3534 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3535 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3536 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3537 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3538 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3539 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3540 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3541 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3542 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003543 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3544 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003545
3546 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3547
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003548 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003549 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3550 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3551 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003552 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3553 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3554 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003555
3556 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3557 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003558 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3559 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3560 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3561 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3562
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003563 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3564 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3565 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3566 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3567 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3568 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3569 parameter.
3570
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003571 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3572 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3573 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3574 used on strings.
3575
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003576 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3577
3578 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3579 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3580 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3581 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3582 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3583 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3584 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3585 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3586 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3587 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3588 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3589 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003590
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003591 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3592 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3593 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003594
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003595 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598http-check disable-on-404
3599 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3605 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3606 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3607 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3608 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3609 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3610 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3611 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003612 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3613 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3614 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3615
3616 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3617
3618
3619http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003620 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003623 Arguments :
3624 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3625 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003626 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003627 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3628 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3629 details on the supported keywords.
3630
3631 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3632 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3633 with the usual backslash ('\').
3634
3635 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3636 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3637 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3638 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3639 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3640
3641 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003643 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3644 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3646
3647 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003648 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003649 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3650 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3651 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3652 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3653
3654 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003655 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003656 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3657 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3658 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3659 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3660 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3661 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3662 trace).
3663
3664 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003665 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003666 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3667 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3668 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3669 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3670 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3671 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3672
3673 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3674 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3675 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3676 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3677 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3678 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3679 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3680 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3681
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003682 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3683 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3684 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3685
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003686 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3687 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3688
3689 Examples :
3690 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003691 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003692
3693 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003694 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003695
3696 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003697 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003698
3699 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003700 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003702 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003703
3704
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003705http-check send-state
3706 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 yes | no | yes | yes
3709 Arguments : none
3710
3711 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3712 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3713 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3714 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3715 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3716
3717 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3718 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3719 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3720 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3721 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003722 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3723 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3724 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3725
3726 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3727 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3728 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3729
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003730 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3731 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3732 checked in multiple backends.
3733
3734 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3735 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3736
3737 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3738 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3739 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3740 one fails.
3741
3742 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3743 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3744 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3745
3746 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3747 server's queue.
3748
3749 Example of a header received by the application server :
3750 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3751 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3752
3753 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3754
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003755http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3756 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003757 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003758 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003759 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003760 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3761 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003762 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3763 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003764 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3765 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3766 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003767 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003768 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003769 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003770 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003771 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003772 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003773 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003774 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003775 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003776 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003777 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3778
3779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 no | yes | yes | yes
3781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003782 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3783 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3784 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3785 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3786 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003787
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003788 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3789 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3790 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3791
3792 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003793 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3794 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3795 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3796 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003797
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003798 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3799 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3800 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003801 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3802 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003803 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3804 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3805 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3806 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3807 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003808 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003809 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3810 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003811
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003812 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3813 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3814 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3815 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3816 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3817
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003818 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3819 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3820 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003821 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3822 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003823
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003824 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3825 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3826 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3827 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3828 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3829 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3830 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3831 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3832
3833 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3834 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3835 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003836 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3837 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003838
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003839 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3840 <name>.
3841
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003842 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3843 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3844 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3845 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3846 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3847 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3848 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3849 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3850
3851 Example:
3852
3853 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3854
3855 applied to:
3856
3857 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3858
3859 outputs:
3860
3861 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3862
3863 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3864
3865 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3866 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3867 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3868 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3869 header.
3870
3871 Example:
3872
3873 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3874
3875 applied to:
3876
3877 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3878
3879 outputs:
3880
3881 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3882
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003883 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3884 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3885 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3886 it.
3887
3888 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3889 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3890 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3891 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3892 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3893 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3894
3895 Example :
3896 # prepend the host name before the path
3897 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3898
3899 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3900 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3901 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3902 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3903 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3904 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3905 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3906 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3907
3908 Example :
3909 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3910 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3911
3912 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3913 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3914 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3915 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3916 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3917 "set-query".
3918
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003919 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3920 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3921 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3922 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3923 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3924 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3925 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3926 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3927
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003928 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3929 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3930 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3931 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3932 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3933 another equipment.
3934
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003935 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3936 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3937 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3938 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3939 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3940 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3941 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3942 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3943
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003944 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3945 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3946 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3947 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3948 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3949 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3950 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3951 admin privileges.
3952
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003953 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3954 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3955 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3956 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3957 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3958 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3959 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3960 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3961
3962 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3963 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3964 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3965 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3966 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3967 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3968
3969 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3970 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3971 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3972 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3973 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3974 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3975
3976 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3977 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3978 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3979 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3980 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3981 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3982 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3983 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3984 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3985
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003986 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003987 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3988 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3989 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3990 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3991 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3992 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3993 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3994 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3995 request header" for more information.
3996
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003997 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3998 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3999 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4000 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004001 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4002 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004003
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004004 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4005 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4006 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4007 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4008 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4009 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4010 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4011 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4012 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4013 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4014 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4015 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4016
4017 These actions take one or two arguments :
4018 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4019 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4020 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4021 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4022
4023 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4024 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4025 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4026 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4027
4028 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4029 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4030 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4031 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4032 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4033 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4034 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4035 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4036
4037 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4038 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4039 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4040 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4041 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4042
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004043 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4044 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4045 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4046 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4047 continues.
4048
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004049 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4050 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4051 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4052 the actions evaluation continues.
4053
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004054 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4055 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4056 inline.
4057
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004058 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4059 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004060 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004061 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4062 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004063 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004064 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004065 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004066 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4067 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004068 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004069 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004070 and '_'.
4071
4072 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4073 followed by some converters.
4074
4075 Example:
4076
4077 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4078
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004079 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4080 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4081
4082 Example:
4083
4084 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4085
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004086 - set-src <expr> :
4087 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4088 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4089 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4090 source IP for privacy.
4091
4092 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4093 followed by some converters.
4094
4095 Example:
4096
4097 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4098 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4099
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004100 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4101 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004102
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004103 - set-src-port <expr> :
4104 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4105 expression.
4106
4107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4108 followed by some converters.
4109
4110 Example:
4111
4112 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4113 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4114
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004115 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4116 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4117 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004118
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004119 - set-dst <expr> :
4120 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4121 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4122 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4123 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4124 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4125
4126 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4127 followed by some converters.
4128
4129 Example:
4130
4131 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4132 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4133
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004134 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4135 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4136
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004137 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4138 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4139 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4140 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4141
4142 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4143 followed by some converters.
4144
4145 Example:
4146
4147 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4148 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4149
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004150 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4151 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4152 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4153
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004154 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4155 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4156 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4157 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4158 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4159 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4160 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4161 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4162 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4163 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4164 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4165 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4166 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4167 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4168 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4169 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4170
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004171
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004172 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4173 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4174 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4175
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004176 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4177 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4178 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4179 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4180 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4181 SPOE agent name must be used.
4182
4183 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4184
4185 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4186 configuration.
4187
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004188 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4189
4190 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4191 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004192 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4193 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4194
4195 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4196 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4197 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4198 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004199
4200 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004201 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4202 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4203 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004204
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004205 http-request allow if nagios
4206 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4207 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4208 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004209
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004210 Example:
4211 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004212 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004213
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004214 Example:
4215 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4216 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004217 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004218 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4219 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4220 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4221 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4222 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4223 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4224
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004225 Example:
4226 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4227 acl add path /addacl
4228 acl del path /delacl
4229
4230 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4231
4232 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4233 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4234
4235 Example:
4236 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4237 acl setmap path /setmap
4238 acl delmap path /delmap
4239
4240 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4241
4242 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4243 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4244
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004245 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4246 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004247
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004248http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004249 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004250 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4252 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004253 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004254 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4255 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4256 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4257 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004258 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004259 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004260 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004261 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004262 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004263 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004264 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004265 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004266 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004267 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004268 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4269
4270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
4273 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4274 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4275 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4276 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4277 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4278 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4279
4280 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4281 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4282 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4283 current section.
4284
4285 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4286 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4287 rules are evaluated.
4288
4289 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4290 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4291 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4292 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4293 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4294 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4295 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4296
4297 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4298 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4299 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4300 external users.
4301
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004302 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4303 <name>.
4304
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004305 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4306 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4307 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4308 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4309 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4310 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4311 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4312 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4313
4314 Example:
4315
4316 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4317
4318 applied to:
4319
4320 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4321
4322 outputs:
4323
4324 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4325
4326 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4327
4328 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4329 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4330 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4331 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4332 header.
4333
4334 Example:
4335
4336 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4337
4338 applied to:
4339
4340 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4341
4342 outputs:
4343
4344 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4345
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004346 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004347 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4348 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4349 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004350
4351 Example:
4352
4353 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4354 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004355 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4356 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004357
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004358 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4359 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4360 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4361 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4362 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4363 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4364 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4365 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4366
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004367 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4368 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4369 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4370 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4371 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4372 another equipment.
4373
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004374 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4375 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4376 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4377 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4378 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4379 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4380 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4381 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4382
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004383 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4384 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4385 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4386 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4387 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4388 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4389 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4390 admin privileges.
4391
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004392 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4393 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4394 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4395 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4396 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4397 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4398 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4399 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4400
4401 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4402 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4403 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4404 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4405 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4406 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4407
4408 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4409 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4410 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4411 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4412 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4413 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4414
4415 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4416 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4417 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4418 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4419 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4420 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4421 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4422 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4423 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4424
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004425 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4426 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4427 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4428 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4429 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4430 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4431 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4432 response header" for more information.
4433
4434 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4435 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4436 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4437 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4438 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004439 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4440 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004441
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004442 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4443 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4444 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4445 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4446 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4447 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4448
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004449 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4450 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4451 inline.
4452
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004453 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4454 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4457 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004458 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004459 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004460 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004461 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4462 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004463 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004464 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4465 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004466
4467 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4468 followed by some converters.
4469
4470 Example:
4471
4472 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4473
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004474 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4475 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4476
4477 Example:
4478
4479 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4480
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004481 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4482 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4483 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4484 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4485 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4486 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4487 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4488
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004489 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4490 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4491 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4492 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4493 continues.
4494
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004495 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4496 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4497 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4498 the actions evaluation continues.
4499
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004500 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4501 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4502 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4503 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4504 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4505 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4506 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4507 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4508 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4509 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4510 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4511 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4512 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4513 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4514 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4515 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4516
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004517 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4518 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4519 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4520 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4521 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4522 SPOE agent name must be used.
4523
4524 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4525
4526 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4527 configuration.
4528
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004529 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4530
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004531 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004532 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4533 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004534 rules.
4535
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004536 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4537 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4538 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4539 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4540
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004541 Example:
4542 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4543
4544 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4545
4546 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4547 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4548
4549 Example:
4550 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4551
4552 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4553
4554 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4555 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4556
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004557 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4558 ACL usage.
4559
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004560
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004561http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4562 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4563
4564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 yes | no | yes | yes
4566
4567 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4568 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4569 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4570 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4571 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4572 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4573
4574 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4575
4576 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4577 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4578 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4579 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4580 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4581 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4582 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4583 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4584 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4585 not checking any request past the first one.
4586
4587 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4588 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4589 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4590 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4591 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4592 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4593 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4594
4595 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4596 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4597 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4598 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4599 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4600 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4601 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4602 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4603 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4604 downsides of rare connection failures.
4605
4606 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4607 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4608 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4609 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4610 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4611 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4612 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4613 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4614 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4615 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4616 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4617 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4618
4619 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4620 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4621 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4622 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4623
4624 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4625 and are never shared ;
4626
4627 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4628 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4629 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4630 and are never shared ;
4631
4632 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4633 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4634 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4635
4636 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4637 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4638 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4639
4640 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4641
4642
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004643http-send-name-header [<header>]
4644 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4645
4646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | no | yes | yes
4648
4649 Arguments :
4650
4651 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4652
4653 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4654 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4655 is added with the header string proved.
4656
4657 See also : "server"
4658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004659id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004660 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4662 no | yes | yes | yes
4663 Arguments : none
4664
4665 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4666 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4667 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004668
4669
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004670ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4671 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674
4675 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4676 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4677 and running).
4678
4679 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4680 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4681 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004682 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004683 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4684
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004685 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4686 "unless" condition is met.
4687
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004688 Example:
4689 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4690 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4691 ignore-persist if url_static
4692
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004693 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4694
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004695load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4696 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699
4700 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4701 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4702 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4703 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4704 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4705 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4706 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4707 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4708
4709 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4710 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004711 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004712
4713 Arguments:
4714 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4715 named "server-state-file".
4716
4717 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4718 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4719 name is used as a file name.
4720
4721 none don't load any stat for this backend
4722
4723 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004724 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4725 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4726 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4727 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4728 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004729
4730 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4731 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4732
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004733 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004734
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004735 global
4736 stats socket /tmp/socket
4737 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004738
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004739 defaults
4740 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004741
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004742 backend bk
4743 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4744 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004745
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004746
4747 Then one can run :
4748
4749 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4750
4751 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4752
4753 1
4754 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4755 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4756 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4757
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004758 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004759
4760 global
4761 stats socket /tmp/socket
4762 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4763
4764 defaults
4765 load-server-state-from-file local
4766
4767 backend bk
4768 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4769 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004771
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004772 Then one can run :
4773
4774 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4775
4776 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4777
4778 1
4779 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4780 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4781 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4782
4783 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4784 "show servers state"
4785
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004787log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004788log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004789no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004793
4794 Prefix :
4795 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4796 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4797 prefix does not allow arguments.
4798
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004799 Arguments :
4800 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4801 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4802 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4803 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4804 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4805 parameter.
4806
4807 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4808 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4809
4810 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4811 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4812 standard syslog port).
4813
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004814 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4815 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4816 standard syslog port).
4817
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004818 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4819 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4820 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4821 appropriately writeable).
4822
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004823 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4824 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004825
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004826 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4827 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4828 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4829 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4830 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4831 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4832 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4833 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4834 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4835 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4836 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4839
4840 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4841 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4842 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4843
4844 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4845 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4846 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004847 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4848 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4849 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4850 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4851 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852
4853 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4854
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004855 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4856 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4857 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004858
4859 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4860 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4861 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4862 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4863
4864 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4865 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004866
4867 Example :
4868 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004869 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4870 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004871 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004873
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004874log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004875 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004878
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004879 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4880 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4881 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4882 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4883 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004884
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004885 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4886 "option httplog" directives.
4887
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004888log-format-sd <string>
4889 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4891 yes | yes | yes | no
4892
4893 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4894 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4895 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4896 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4897 which covers the log format string in depth.
4898
4899 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4900 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4901
4902 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4903 log format to "rfc5424".
4904
4905 Example :
4906 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4907
4908
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004909log-tag <string>
4910 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4912 yes | yes | yes | yes
4913
4914 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4915 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4916 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4917 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4918 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4919 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4920 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4921 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4922 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004923
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004924max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4925 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 yes | no | yes | yes
4928
4929 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4930 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4931 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4932 servers.
4933
4934 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4935 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4936 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4937 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4938 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4939 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4940 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4941 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4942 picking a different server.
4943
4944 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4945 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4946 even if they have to be queued.
4947
4948 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4949 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4950
4951
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004952maxconn <conns>
4953 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | yes | yes | no
4956 Arguments :
4957 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4958 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4959 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4960 closes.
4961
4962 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4963 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4964 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4965 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004966 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4967 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4968 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4969 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970
4971 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4972 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4973 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4974
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004975 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4976
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004977 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4978
4979
4980mode { tcp|http|health }
4981 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
4984 Arguments :
4985 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4986 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4987 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4988 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4989
4990 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4991 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4992 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4993 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4994 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4995
4996 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004997 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4998 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4999 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5000 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5001 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5002 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5003 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005004
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005005 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5006 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5007 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005008
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005009 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005010 defaults http_instances
5011 mode http
5012
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005013 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005016monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005017 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005020 Arguments :
5021 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5022 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005023 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005024 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5025 backend and its backup.
5026
5027 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5028 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5029 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5030 servers in a list of backends.
5031
5032 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5033 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5034 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5035 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5036 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5037 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5038 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005039 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5040 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005041
5042 Example:
5043 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005044 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005045 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5046 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5047 monitor-uri /site_alive
5048 monitor fail if site_dead
5049
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005050 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005051
5052
5053monitor-net <source>
5054 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | yes | yes | no
5057 Arguments :
5058 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5059 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5060 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5061 followed by a mask.
5062
5063 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5064 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005065 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005066 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5067
5068 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5069 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5070 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5071 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005072 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5073 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5074 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005075
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005076 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5077 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5078 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5079 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5080 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5081 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005082
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005083 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5084 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005085
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005086 Example :
5087 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5088 frontend www
5089 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5090
5091 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5092
5093
5094monitor-uri <uri>
5095 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5097 yes | yes | yes | no
5098 Arguments :
5099 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5100 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5101
5102 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5103 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5104 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5105 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5106 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5107 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5108 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5109 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5110
5111 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5112 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5113 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5114 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5115 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5116 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5117
5118 Example :
5119 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5120 frontend www
5121 mode http
5122 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5123
5124 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005126
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005127option abortonclose
5128no option abortonclose
5129 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5131 yes | no | yes | yes
5132 Arguments : none
5133
5134 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5135 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5136 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5137 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005138 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5140 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5141 encountered while delivering the response.
5142
5143 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5144 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5145 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5146 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5147 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5148 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005149 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005150 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005151 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005152 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5153 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5154 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5155
5156 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5157 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5158 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5159 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5160 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5161 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5162 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5163 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005164 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005165
5166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5168
5169 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5170
5171
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005172option accept-invalid-http-request
5173no option accept-invalid-http-request
5174 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | yes | yes | no
5177 Arguments : none
5178
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005179 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005180 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5181 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5182 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5183 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5184 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5185 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5186 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005187 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5188 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5189 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5190 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5191 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005192 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005193 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5194 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5195 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005196
5197 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5198 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5199 been confirmed.
5200
5201 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5202 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005203 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5204 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005205 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5206
5207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5209
5210 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5211 stats socket.
5212
5213
5214option accept-invalid-http-response
5215no option accept-invalid-http-response
5216 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5218 yes | no | yes | yes
5219 Arguments : none
5220
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005221 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005222 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5223 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5224 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5225 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5226 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5227 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5228 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005229 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5230 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5231 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005232
5233 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5234 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5235 been confirmed.
5236
5237 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5238 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5239 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5240 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5241
5242 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5243 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5244
5245 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5246 stats socket.
5247
5248
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005249option allbackups
5250no option allbackups
5251 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | no | yes | yes
5254 Arguments : none
5255
5256 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5257 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5258 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5259 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5260 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5261 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5262 order between the backup servers anymore.
5263
5264 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5265 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5266
5267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5269
5270
5271option checkcache
5272no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005273 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 yes | no | yes | yes
5276 Arguments : none
5277
5278 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5279 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005280 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005281 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5282 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005283 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005284
5285 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005286 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005287 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005288 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5289 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005290 to the client are :
5291 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005292 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005293 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005294 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5295 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5296 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5297 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5298 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5299 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5300 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5301 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5302 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5303 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5304 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5305
5306 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005307 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005308 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005309 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005310 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5311
5312 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5313 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005314 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005315 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5316
5317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5319
5320
5321option clitcpka
5322no option clitcpka
5323 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | no
5326 Arguments : none
5327
5328 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5329 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5330 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5331 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5332
5333 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5334 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5335 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5336 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5337
5338 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5339 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5340 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5341 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5342 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5343
5344 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5345
5346 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5347 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5348 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5349
5350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5352
5353 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5354
5355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005356option contstats
5357 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | yes | yes | no
5360 Arguments : none
5361
5362 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5363 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5364 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5365 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005366 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5367 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5368 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5369 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5370 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005371
5372
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005373option dontlog-normal
5374no option dontlog-normal
5375 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | yes | yes | no
5378 Arguments : none
5379
5380 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5381 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5382 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5383 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5384 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5385 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5386 logged.
5387
5388 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5389 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5390 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005392 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005393 logging.
5394
5395
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005396option dontlognull
5397no option dontlognull
5398 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 yes | yes | yes | no
5401 Arguments : none
5402
5403 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5404 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5405 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5406 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5407 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5408 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005409 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5410 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5411 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005412
5413 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5414 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5415 would not be logged.
5416
5417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5419
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005420 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5421 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005422
5423
5424option forceclose
5425no option forceclose
5426 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005429 Arguments : none
5430
5431 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5432 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5433 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5434 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5435 global session times in the logs.
5436
5437 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005438 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005439 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005440
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005441 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5442 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5443 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5444
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005445 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5446 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005447
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5450
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005451 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005452
5453
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005454option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005455 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 yes | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments :
5459 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5460 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005461 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005462 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005463
5464 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5465 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5466 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5467 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5468 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5469 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5470 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005471 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5472 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5473 possible that the client has already brought one.
5474
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005475 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005476 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005477 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5478 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005479 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5480 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005481
5482 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5483 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5484 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5485 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5486 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5487 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5488 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5489
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005490 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5491 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5492 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5493 are under the control of the end-user.
5494
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005495 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005496 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5497 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005498 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5499 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5500 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005502 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005503 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5504 frontend www
5505 mode http
5506 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5507
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005508 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5509 backend www
5510 mode http
5511 option forwardfor header X-Client
5512
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005513 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005514 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005515
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005516
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005517option http-buffer-request
5518no option http-buffer-request
5519 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5521 yes | yes | yes | yes
5522 Arguments : none
5523
5524 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5525 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5526 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5527 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5528 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5529 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5530 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5531 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005532 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005533 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5534 default.
5535
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005536 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005537
5538
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005539option http-ignore-probes
5540no option http-ignore-probes
5541 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 yes | yes | yes | no
5544 Arguments : none
5545
5546 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5547 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5548 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5549 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5550 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5551 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5552 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5553 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5554 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5555 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5556 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5557 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5558
5559 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5560 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5561 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5562 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5563 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5564 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5565 are often the only way to detect them.
5566
5567 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5568 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5569
5570 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5571
5572
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005573option http-keep-alive
5574no option http-keep-alive
5575 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 yes | yes | yes | yes
5578 Arguments : none
5579
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005580 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5581 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5582 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5583 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5584 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5585 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5586 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5587
5588 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5589 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005590 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5591 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5592 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5593 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5594 situations where this option may be useful :
5595
5596 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5597 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5598
5599 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5600 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5601
5602 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5603 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5604 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5605 request.
5606
5607 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5608 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005609 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5610 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5611 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005612
5613 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5614 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5615
5616 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5617 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5618 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5619 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5620 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5621 not set.
5622
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005623 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5624 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005625 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005626 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005627
5628 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005629 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5630 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005631
5632
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005633option http-no-delay
5634no option http-no-delay
5635 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | yes | yes | yes
5638 Arguments : none
5639
5640 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5641 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5642 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5643 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5644 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5645 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5646 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5647 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5648 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5649 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5650 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5651 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5652 affected.
5653
5654 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5655 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5656 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5657 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5658 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5659 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5660 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5661 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5662 latency environments.
5663
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005664 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5665
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005666
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005667option http-pretend-keepalive
5668no option http-pretend-keepalive
5669 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 yes | yes | yes | yes
5672 Arguments : none
5673
5674 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5675 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5676 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5677 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5678 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5679 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5680 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5681 consider the response complete.
5682
5683 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5684 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5685 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5686 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5687 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5688 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5689
5690 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5691 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5692 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5693 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5694 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5695 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5696 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5697
5698 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5699 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005700 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005701 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5702 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005703
5704 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5705 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5706
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005707 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5708 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005709
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005710
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005711option http-server-close
5712no option http-server-close
5713 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5715 yes | yes | yes | yes
5716 Arguments : none
5717
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005718 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5719 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5720 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5721 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5722 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5723 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5724 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5725 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5726 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5727 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5728 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005729 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005730 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5731 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5732 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5733 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005734
5735 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5736 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5737 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5738 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005739 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5740 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005741
5742 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5743 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005744 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5745 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005746 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5747 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005748
5749 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5750 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5751
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005752 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005753 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5754 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005755
5756
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005757option http-tunnel
5758no option http-tunnel
5759 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5761 yes | yes | yes | yes
5762 Arguments : none
5763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005764 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5765 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5766 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5767 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5768 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5769 "option http-tunnel".
5770
5771 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005772 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005773 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5774 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5775 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5776 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5777 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5778 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5779 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005780
5781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5783
5784 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5785 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5786 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5787
5788
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005789option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005790no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005791 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | yes | yes | no
5794 Arguments : none
5795
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005796 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005797 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5798 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5799 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5800 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5801 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5802 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5803
5804 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5805 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005806 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5807 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5808 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005809
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005810 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5811 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5812 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5813 front of an existing proxy.
5814
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005815 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5816
5817 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5818 http-server-close".
5819
5820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005821option httpchk
5822option httpchk <uri>
5823option httpchk <method> <uri>
5824option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5825 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 yes | no | yes | yes
5828 Arguments :
5829 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5830 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5831 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5832 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5833 ones.
5834
5835 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5836 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5837 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5838
5839 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5840 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5841 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5842 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5843 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5844
5845 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5846 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5847 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5848 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5849 the lack of any response.
5850
5851 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5852
5853 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5854 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5855 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5856
5857 Examples :
5858 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5859 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5860 backend https_relay
5861 mode tcp
5862 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5863 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5864
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005865 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5866 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5867 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005868
5869
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005870option httpclose
5871no option httpclose
5872 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | yes | yes | yes
5875 Arguments : none
5876
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005877 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5878 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5879 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5880 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005881 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005882 "option http-tunnel".
5883
5884 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5885 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5886 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5887 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5888 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5889 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5890 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5891 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005892
5893 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005894 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005895 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5896 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5897 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5898 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5899 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005900
5901 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5902 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005903 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5904 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005905 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5906 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005907
5908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5910
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005911 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5912 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005913
5914
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005915option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005916 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005919 Arguments :
5920 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5921 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5922 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5923 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5924 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005925
5926 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5927 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5928 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5929 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5930 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5931 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5932 ports.
5933
5934 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5935
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005936 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5937 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005938
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005939 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005941 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005942
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005943
5944option http_proxy
5945no option http_proxy
5946 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5948 yes | yes | yes | yes
5949 Arguments : none
5950
5951 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5952 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5953 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5954 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5955 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5956
5957 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5958 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005959 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5960 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005961
5962 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5963 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5964
5965 Example :
5966 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5967 backend direct_forward
5968 option httpclose
5969 option http_proxy
5970
5971 See also : "option httpclose"
5972
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005973
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005974option independent-streams
5975no option independent-streams
5976 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | yes | yes | yes
5979 Arguments : none
5980
5981 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5982 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5983 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5984 receive data or not.
5985
5986 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5987 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5988 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5989 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5990 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5991 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5992 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5993 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5994 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5995 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5996 socket buffers.
5997
5998 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5999 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6000 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6001 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6002 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6003
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006004 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006005 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6006 deprecated.
6007
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006008 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006009
6010
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006011option ldap-check
6012 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 yes | no | yes | yes
6015 Arguments : none
6016
6017 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6018 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6019 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6020 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6021
6022 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6023 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6024
6025 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6026 configure it.
6027
6028 Example :
6029 option ldap-check
6030
6031 See also : "option httpchk"
6032
6033
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006034option external-check
6035 Use external processes for server health checks
6036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6037 yes | no | yes | yes
6038
6039 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6040 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6041 command".
6042
6043 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6044
6045 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6046
6047
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006048option log-health-checks
6049no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006050 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 yes | no | yes | yes
6053 Arguments : none
6054
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006055 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6056 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6057 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006058
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006059 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6060 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6061 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6062 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6063 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6064
6065 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6066 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006067
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006068 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6069 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6070 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006071
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006072
6073option log-separate-errors
6074no option log-separate-errors
6075 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | yes | yes | no
6078 Arguments : none
6079
6080 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6081 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6082 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6083 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6084 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6085 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6086 provides very important information.
6087
6088 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6089 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6090 error logs.
6091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006092 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006093 logging.
6094
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006095
6096option logasap
6097no option logasap
6098 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6100 yes | yes | yes | no
6101 Arguments : none
6102
6103 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6104 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6105 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6106 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6107 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6108 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6109 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006110 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006111 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6112 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006114 Examples :
6115 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6116 mode http
6117 option httplog
6118 option logasap
6119 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6120
6121 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6122 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6123 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6124 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006126 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006127 logging.
6128
6129
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006130option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006131 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6133 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006134 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006135 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6136 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006137 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006138
6139 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6140 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6141 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6142 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6143 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6144 in the MySQL table, like this :
6145
6146 USE mysql;
6147 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6148 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6149
6150 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6151 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6152 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6153 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6154 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6155 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6156 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6157 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6158 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6159
6160 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6161 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006162
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006163 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006164
6165 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6166 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6167 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6168 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006169 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6170 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006171
6172 See also: "option httpchk"
6173
6174
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006175option nolinger
6176no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006177 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006180 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006181
6182 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6183 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6184 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6185 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6186 connections.
6187
6188 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6189 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6190 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6191 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6192 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6193 this too.
6194
6195 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6196 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6197 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6198
6199 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6200 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6201 for servers.
6202
6203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6205
6206
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006207option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6208 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6210 yes | yes | yes | yes
6211 Arguments :
6212 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6213 matching <network>
6214 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6215 header name.
6216
6217 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6218 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6219 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6220 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6221 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6222 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6223 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6224 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6225 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6226 possible that the client has already brought one.
6227
6228 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6229 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6230 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6231 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6232 header and requires different one.
6233
6234 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6235 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6236 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6237 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6238 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6239 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6240 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6241
6242 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6243 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6244 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6245 both are defined.
6246
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006247 Examples :
6248 # Original Destination address
6249 frontend www
6250 mode http
6251 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6252
6253 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6254 backend www
6255 mode http
6256 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6257
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006258 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6259 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006260
6261
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006262option persist
6263no option persist
6264 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006267 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006268
6269 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6270 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6271 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6272 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6273 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6274 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6275 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6276 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6277 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6278 redirected to another valid server.
6279
6280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6282
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006283 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006284
6285
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006286option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6287 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | no | yes | yes
6290 Arguments :
6291 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6292 PostgreSQL server.
6293
6294 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6295 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6296 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6297 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6298
6299 See also: "option httpchk"
6300
6301
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006302option prefer-last-server
6303no option prefer-last-server
6304 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | no | yes | yes
6307 Arguments : none
6308
6309 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6310 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6311 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6312 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6313 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6314 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6315 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6316 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6317 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006318 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6319 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6320 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6321 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6322 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6323 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6324 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006325
6326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6328
6329 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6330
6331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006332option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006333option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006334no option redispatch
6335 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6336 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006338 Arguments :
6339 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6340 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6341 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6342 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6343 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6344 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6345 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6346 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6347 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006349
6350 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6351 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6352 be able to access the service anymore.
6353
6354 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6355 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6356
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006357 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006358 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6359 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006361 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6362 "redisp" keywords.
6363
6364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6366
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006367 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006368
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006369
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006370option redis-check
6371 Use redis health checks for server testing
6372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6373 yes | no | yes | yes
6374 Arguments : none
6375
6376 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6377 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6378 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6379 find the "+PONG" response message.
6380
6381 Example :
6382 option redis-check
6383
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006384 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006385
6386
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006387option smtpchk
6388option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6389 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6391 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006393 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6394 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6395 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6396
6397 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6398 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6399 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6400
6401 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6402 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6403 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6404 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6405 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6406 dead server.
6407
6408 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6409 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6410 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6411 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6412
6413 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6414 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6415 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6416 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006417 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006418
6419 Example :
6420 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6421
6422 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006425option socket-stats
6426no option socket-stats
6427
6428 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | no
6431
6432 Arguments : none
6433
6434
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006435option splice-auto
6436no option splice-auto
6437 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6439 yes | yes | yes | yes
6440 Arguments : none
6441
6442 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6443 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6444 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6445 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006446 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006447 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6448 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6449 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6450 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6451
6452 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6453 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6454 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6455 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6456 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6457 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6458 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6459 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6460 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6461 keyword.
6462
6463 Example :
6464 option splice-auto
6465
6466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6468
6469 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6470 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6471
6472
6473option splice-request
6474no option splice-request
6475 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | yes | yes | yes
6478 Arguments : none
6479
6480 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006481 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006482 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6483 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6484 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6485 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6486
6487 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6488
6489 Example :
6490 option splice-request
6491
6492 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6493 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6494
6495 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6496 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6497
6498
6499option splice-response
6500no option splice-response
6501 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6503 yes | yes | yes | yes
6504 Arguments : none
6505
6506 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006507 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006508 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6509 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6510 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6511 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6512
6513 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6514
6515 Example :
6516 option splice-response
6517
6518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6520
6521 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6522 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6523
6524
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006525option spop-check
6526 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 no | no | no | yes
6529 Arguments : none
6530
6531 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6532 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6533 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6534 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6535
6536 Example :
6537 option spop-check
6538
6539 See also : "option httpchk"
6540
6541
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006542option srvtcpka
6543no option srvtcpka
6544 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | no | yes | yes
6547 Arguments : none
6548
6549 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6550 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6551 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6552 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6553
6554 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6555 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6556 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6557 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6558
6559 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6560 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6561 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6562 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6563 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6564
6565 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6566
6567 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6568 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6569 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6570
6571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6573
6574 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6575
6576
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006577option ssl-hello-chk
6578 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6580 yes | no | yes | yes
6581 Arguments : none
6582
6583 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6584 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6585 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6586 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6587 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6588 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6589 hello message.
6590
6591 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6592 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6593 messages, which is appreciable.
6594
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006595 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6596 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6597 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006598
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006599 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6600
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006601
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006602option tcp-check
6603 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6605 yes | no | yes | yes
6606
6607 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6608 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6609
6610 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6611 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6612 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6613
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006614 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006615 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6616 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6617 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6618 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6619 only.
6620
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006621 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006622 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6623 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6624 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6625 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6626
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006627 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006628 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6629 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006630 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006631 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6632 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6633 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6634 the respective protocols.
6635 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6636 analysed.
6637
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006638 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6639 script.
6640
6641 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6642 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6643 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6644 The "comment" is of course optional.
6645
6646
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006647 Examples :
6648 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6649 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006650 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006651
6652 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6653 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006654 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006655
6656 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6657 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006658 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006659 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006660 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006661 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006662 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006663 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006664 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6665 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006666 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006667 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6668 tcp-check expect string +OK
6669
6670 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6671 (send many headers before analyzing)
6672 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006673 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006674 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6675 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6676 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6677 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006678 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006679
6680
6681 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6682
6683
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006684option tcp-smart-accept
6685no option tcp-smart-accept
6686 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6688 yes | yes | yes | no
6689 Arguments : none
6690
6691 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6692 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6693 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6694 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6695 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6696 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6697
6698 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6699 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6700 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6701 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6702
6703 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6704 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6705 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6706 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6707
6708 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6709 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6710 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6711
6712 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6713 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6714 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6715
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006716 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6717
6718
6719option tcp-smart-connect
6720no option tcp-smart-connect
6721 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6723 yes | no | yes | yes
6724 Arguments : none
6725
6726 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6727 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6728 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6729 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6730 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6731
6732 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6733 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6734 complex.
6735
6736 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6737 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6738 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6739
6740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6742
6743 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6744
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006745
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006746option tcpka
6747 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | yes | yes | yes
6750 Arguments : none
6751
6752 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6753 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6754 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6755 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6756
6757 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6758 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6759 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6760 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6761
6762 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6763 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6764 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6765 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6766 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6767
6768 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6769
6770 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6771 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6772 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6773 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6774 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6775 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6776 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6777 backends.
6778
6779 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6780
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006781
6782option tcplog
6783 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6785 yes | yes | yes | yes
6786 Arguments : none
6787
6788 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6789 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6790 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6791 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6792 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6793 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6794 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6795 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6796
6797 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6798
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006799 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006801 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006802
6803
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006804option transparent
6805no option transparent
6806 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006809 Arguments : none
6810
6811 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6812 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6813 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6814 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6815 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6816 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6817 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6818 appropriate server.
6819
6820 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6821 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6822
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006823 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006824 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006825
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006826
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006827external-check command <command>
6828 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6830 yes | no | yes | yes
6831
6832 Arguments :
6833 <command> is the external command to run
6834
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006835 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6836
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006837 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006838
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006839 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6840 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6841 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6842 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6843 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6844 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006845
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006846 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6847
6848 Environment variables :
6849 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6850 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6851
6852 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6853
6854 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6855
6856 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6857 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6858 for a UNIX socket).
6859
6860 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6861
6862 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6863
6864 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6865
6866 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6867
6868 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6869
6870 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6871 socket).
6872
6873 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6874 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6875
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006876 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6877 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6878 failed.
6879
6880 Example :
6881 external-check command /bin/true
6882
6883 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6884
6885
6886external-check path <path>
6887 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6889 yes | no | yes | yes
6890
6891 Arguments :
6892 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6893
6894 The default path is "".
6895
6896 Example :
6897 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6898
6899 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6900 "external-check command"
6901
6902
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006903persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006904persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006905 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6907 yes | no | yes | yes
6908 Arguments :
6909 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006910 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6911 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006912
6913 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6914 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6915 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6916 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6917 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6918 forwarded to this server.
6919
6920 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6921 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6922 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006923 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006924 a single "listen" section.
6925
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006926 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6927 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6928 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6929
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006930 Example :
6931 listen tse-farm
6932 bind :3389
6933 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6934 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6935 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6936 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6937 persist rdp-cookie
6938 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006939 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006940 balance rdp-cookie
6941 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6942 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6943
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006944 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6945 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006946
6947
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006948rate-limit sessions <rate>
6949 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 yes | yes | yes | no
6952 Arguments :
6953 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6954 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6955
6956 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6957 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6958 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6959 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6960 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6961 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6962
6963 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6964 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6965 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6966 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6967
6968 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6969 listen smtp
6970 mode tcp
6971 bind :25
6972 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006973 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006974
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006975 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6976 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6977 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006978
6979 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6980
6981
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006982redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6983redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6984redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006985 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 no | yes | yes | yes
6988
6989 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006990 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006991
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006992 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006993 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006994 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6995 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6996 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006997
6998 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6999 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7000 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7001 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7002 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007003 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7004 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7005 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7006 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007007
7008 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7009 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7010 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7011 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7012 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7013 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007014 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007015 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007016 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7017 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7018 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007019
7020 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007021 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7022 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7023 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007024 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007025 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7026 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7027 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7028 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007029
7030 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7031 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7032
7033 - "drop-query"
7034 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7035 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7036 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7037 with a location-type redirect.
7038
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007039 - "append-slash"
7040 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7041 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7042 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7043 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7044
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007045 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7046 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7047 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7048 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7049 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7050 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7051 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7052
7053 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7054 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7055 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7056 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7057 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7058 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7059 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007060
7061 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7062 acl clear dst_port 80
7063 acl secure dst_port 8080
7064 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007065 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007066 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007067 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7068
7069 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007070 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7071 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7072 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007073 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007074
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007075 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7076 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7077 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7078
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007079 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007080 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007081
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007082 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007083 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7084 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7085 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007087 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007088
7089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007090redisp (deprecated)
7091redispatch (deprecated)
7092 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7093 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7094 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007095 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007096
7097 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7098 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7099 be able to access the service anymore.
7100
7101 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7102 redistribute them to a working server.
7103
7104 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7105 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7106 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007108 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7109 "option redispatch" instead.
7110
7111 See also : "option redispatch"
7112
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007113
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007114reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007115 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7117 no | yes | yes | yes
7118 Arguments :
7119 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7120 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007121 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007122
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007123 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7124 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7125
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007126 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7127 the last header of an HTTP request.
7128
7129 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7130 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7131 responses.
7132
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007133 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7134 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7135 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7136
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007137 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7138 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007139
7140
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007141reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7142reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 no | yes | yes | yes
7146 Arguments :
7147 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7148 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7149 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7150 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7151 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7152 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7153 ignores case.
7154
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007155 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7156 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7157
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007158 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7159 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7160 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7161 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007162 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163
7164 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7165 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7166
7167 Example :
7168 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7169 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7170 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7171
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007172 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7173 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007174
7175
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007176reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7177reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007178 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 no | yes | yes | yes
7181 Arguments :
7182 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7183 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7184 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7185 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7186 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7187 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7188
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007189 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7190 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7191
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007192 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7193 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7194 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7195 next servers.
7196
7197 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7198 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7199 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7200
7201 Example :
7202 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7203 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7204 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7205
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007206 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7207 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007208
7209
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007210reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7211reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007212 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 no | yes | yes | yes
7215 Arguments :
7216 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7217 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7218 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7219 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7220 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7221 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7222 case.
7223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007224 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7225 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7226
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007227 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7228 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7229 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7230 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007231 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007232
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007233 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007234 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007235 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007237 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7238 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7239
7240 Example :
7241 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7242 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7243 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7244
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007245 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7246 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007247
7248
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007249reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7250reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 no | yes | yes | yes
7254 Arguments :
7255 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7256 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7257 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7258 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7259 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7260 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7261 case.
7262
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007263 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7264 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7265
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007266 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7267 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7268 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7269 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7270
7271 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7272 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7273
7274 Example :
7275 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7276 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7277 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7278 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7279
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007280 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7281 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007282
7283
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007284reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7285reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007286 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7288 no | yes | yes | yes
7289 Arguments :
7290 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7291 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7292 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7293 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7294 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7295 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7296
7297 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7298 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7299 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7300 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007301 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007302
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007303 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7304 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7305
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007306 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7307 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7308 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7309
7310 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7311 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7312 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7313 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7314 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7315
7316 Example :
7317 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007318 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007319 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7320 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7321
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007322 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7323 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324
7325
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007326reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7327reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007328 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 no | yes | yes | yes
7331 Arguments :
7332 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7333 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7334 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7335 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7336 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7337 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7338 ignores case.
7339
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007340 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7341 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7342
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007343 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7344 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007345 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7346 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7347 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7349 not set.
7350
7351 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7352 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7353 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7354 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7355 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7356
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007357 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007358 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7359 # block all others.
7360 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7361 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7362
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007363 # block bad guys
7364 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7365 reqitarpit . if badguys
7366
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007367 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7368 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369
7370
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007371retries <value>
7372 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | no | yes | yes
7375 Arguments :
7376 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7377 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7378 default value is 3.
7379
7380 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7381 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7382 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7383
7384 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007385 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7386 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007387
7388 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7389 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7390
7391 See also : "option redispatch"
7392
7393
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007394rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007395 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7397 no | yes | yes | yes
7398 Arguments :
7399 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7400 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007401 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007402
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007403 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7404 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7405
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7407 the last header of an HTTP response.
7408
7409 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7410 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7411 responses.
7412
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007413 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7414 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007415
7416
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007417rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7418rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007419 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 no | yes | yes | yes
7422 Arguments :
7423 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7424 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7425 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7426 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7427 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7428 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7429 ignores case.
7430
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007434 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7435 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007436 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437 client.
7438
7439 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7440 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7441 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7442
7443 Example :
7444 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007445 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007446
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007447 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7448 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007449
7450
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007451rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7452rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007453 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 no | yes | yes | yes
7456 Arguments :
7457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7458 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7459 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7460 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7461 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7462 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7463 ignores case.
7464
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007468 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7469 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7470 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7471 case-sensitive.
7472
7473 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007474 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7475 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7476 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007477
7478 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7479 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7480
7481 Example :
7482 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7483 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7484
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007485 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7486 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007487
7488
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007489rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7490rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007491 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7493 no | yes | yes | yes
7494 Arguments :
7495 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7496 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7497 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7498 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7499 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7500 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7501 ignores case.
7502
7503 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7504 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7505 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7506 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007507 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007508
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007512 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7513 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7514 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7515
7516 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7517 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7518 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7519 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7520 are not case-sensitive.
7521
7522 Example :
7523 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7524 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7525
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007526 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7527 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007528
7529
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007530server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007531 Declare a server in a backend
7532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7533 no | no | yes | yes
7534 Arguments :
7535 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007536 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007537 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007538
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007539 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7540 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7541 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7542 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007543 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7544 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7545 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7546 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7547 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007548 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7549 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7550 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7551 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7552 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7553 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7554 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007555 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007556 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7557 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007558 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7559 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007560
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007561 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007562 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7563 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7564 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7565 adding this value to the client's port.
7566
7567 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7568 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007569 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007570
7571 Examples :
7572 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7573 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007574 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007575 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7576 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7577 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007579 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7580 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7581 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7582 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7583 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7584
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007585 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7586 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007587
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007588server-state-file-name [<file>]
7589 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7590 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7591 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7592 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7593 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7594 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7595
7596 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7597 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7598
7599 global
7600 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7601
7602 backend bk
7603 load-server-state-from-file
7604
7605 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7606 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007607
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007608server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7609 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7610 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 no | no | yes | yes
7613
7614 Arguments:
7615 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7616
7617 <num | range>
7618 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7619 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7620 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7621 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7622
7623 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7624
7625 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7626
7627 <params*>
7628 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7629 keyword.
7630
7631 Examples:
7632 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7633 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7634 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7635
7636 # or
7637 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7638
7639 # would be equivalent to:
7640 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7641 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7642 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7643
7644
7645
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007646source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007647source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007648source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007649 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7651 yes | no | yes | yes
7652 Arguments :
7653 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7654 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007655
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007656 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007657 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7658 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7659 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7660 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7661 supported prefixes are :
7662 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7663 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7664 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007665 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007666 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7667 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007668
7669 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7670 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007671 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7672 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7673 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007674
7675 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7676 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7677 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7678 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7679 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7680 <addr>.
7681
7682 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7683 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7684 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7685 port.
7686
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007687 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7688 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7689 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7690 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007691 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007692 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7693 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7694 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7695 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7696 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7697 HTTP header.
7698
7699 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7700 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007701 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007702 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7703 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7704 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7705 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7706 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7707 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7708 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7709
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007710 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7711 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7712 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7713 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7714 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7715 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7716
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7718 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7719 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7720 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7721
7722 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7723 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7724 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7725 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7726 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7727 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7728
7729 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7730 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7731 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7732 there are two methods :
7733
7734 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7735 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7736 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7737 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7738 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7739 of the client ranges may be used.
7740
7741 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7742 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7743 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7744 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7745 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7746 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7747 same session.
7748
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007749 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7750 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7751 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007752 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007753
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007754 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7755
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007756 Examples :
7757 backend private
7758 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7759 source 192.168.1.200
7760
7761 backend transparent_ssl1
7762 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7763 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7764
7765 backend transparent_ssl2
7766 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7767 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7768 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7769
7770 backend transparent_ssl3
7771 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7772 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7773 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7774
7775 backend transparent_smtp
7776 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7777 # with Tproxy version 4.
7778 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7779
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007780 backend transparent_http
7781 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7782 # proxy.
7783 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007785 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007786 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007789srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7790 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7792 yes | no | yes | yes
7793 Arguments :
7794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7796 as explained at the top of this document.
7797
7798 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7799 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7800 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7801 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7802 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7803 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7804 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7805
7806 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7807 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7808 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7809 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7810 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007811 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007812 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007813 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007814
7815 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7816 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7817 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7818 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7819 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7820 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7821
7822 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7823 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7824
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007825 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7826 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007827
7828
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007829stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7830 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007832 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007833
7834 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7835 matched.
7836
7837 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7838 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7839
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007840 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7841 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7842 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7843
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007844 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7845 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7846 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7847 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007848
7849 Example :
7850 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7851 backend stats_localhost
7852 stats enable
7853 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7854
7855 Example :
7856 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7857 backend stats_auth
7858 stats enable
7859 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7860 stats admin if TRUE
7861
7862 Example :
7863 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7864 userlist stats-auth
7865 group admin users admin
7866 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7867 group readonly users haproxy
7868 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7869
7870 backend stats_auth
7871 stats enable
7872 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7873 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7874 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7875 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7876
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007877 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7878 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7879 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007880
7881
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007882stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7883 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007885 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007886 Arguments :
7887 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7888
7889 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7890
7891 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7892 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7893 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7894 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7895 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7896 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7897
7898 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7899 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7900 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007901 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007902
7903 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7904 report using "stats scope".
7905
7906 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7907 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7908 unobvious parameters.
7909
7910 Example :
7911 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7912 backend public_www
7913 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7914 stats enable
7915 stats hide-version
7916 stats scope .
7917 stats uri /admin?stats
7918 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7919 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7920 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7921
7922 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7923 backend private_monitoring
7924 stats enable
7925 stats uri /admin?stats
7926 stats refresh 5s
7927
7928 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7929
7930
7931stats enable
7932 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007934 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007935 Arguments : none
7936
7937 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7938 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7939 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7940 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7941 - stats auth : no authentication
7942 - stats scope : no restriction
7943
7944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7946 unobvious parameters.
7947
7948 Example :
7949 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7950 backend public_www
7951 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7952 stats enable
7953 stats hide-version
7954 stats scope .
7955 stats uri /admin?stats
7956 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7957 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7958 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7959
7960 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7961 backend private_monitoring
7962 stats enable
7963 stats uri /admin?stats
7964 stats refresh 5s
7965
7966 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7967
7968
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007969stats hide-version
7970 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007972 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007973 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007974
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007975 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7976 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7977 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7978 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7979 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7980 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007982 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7983 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7984 unobvious parameters.
7985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007986 Example :
7987 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7988 backend public_www
7989 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007990 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007991 stats hide-version
7992 stats scope .
7993 stats uri /admin?stats
7994 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7995 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7996 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007997
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007998 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7999 backend private_monitoring
8000 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008001 stats uri /admin?stats
8002 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008003
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008005
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008006
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008007stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8009 Access control for statistics
8010
8011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8012 no | no | yes | yes
8013
8014 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8015 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8016 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8017 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8018 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8019 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8020
8021 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8022 instance.
8023
8024 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8025 about ACL usage.
8026
8027
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008028stats realm <realm>
8029 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008031 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008032 Arguments :
8033 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8034 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8035 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8036
8037 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8038 using a backslash ('\').
8039
8040 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8041 only related to authentication.
8042
8043 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8044 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8045 unobvious parameters.
8046
8047 Example :
8048 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8049 backend public_www
8050 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8051 stats enable
8052 stats hide-version
8053 stats scope .
8054 stats uri /admin?stats
8055 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8056 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8057 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8058
8059 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8060 backend private_monitoring
8061 stats enable
8062 stats uri /admin?stats
8063 stats refresh 5s
8064
8065 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8066
8067
8068stats refresh <delay>
8069 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008071 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008072 Arguments :
8073 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8074 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8075 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8076 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8077 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8078 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8079
8080 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8081 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8082 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8083 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8084
8085 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8086 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8087 unobvious parameters.
8088
8089 Example :
8090 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8091 backend public_www
8092 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8093 stats enable
8094 stats hide-version
8095 stats scope .
8096 stats uri /admin?stats
8097 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8098 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8099 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8100
8101 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8102 backend private_monitoring
8103 stats enable
8104 stats uri /admin?stats
8105 stats refresh 5s
8106
8107 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8108
8109
8110stats scope { <name> | "." }
8111 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008114 Arguments :
8115 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8116 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8117 section in which the statement appears.
8118
8119 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8120 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8121 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8122 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8123 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8124 exists.
8125
8126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8128 unobvious parameters.
8129
8130 Example :
8131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8132 backend public_www
8133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8134 stats enable
8135 stats hide-version
8136 stats scope .
8137 stats uri /admin?stats
8138 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8141
8142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8143 backend private_monitoring
8144 stats enable
8145 stats uri /admin?stats
8146 stats refresh 5s
8147
8148 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8149
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008150
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008151stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008152 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008155
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008156 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008157 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8158
8159 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8160 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8161
8162 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8163 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008164 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008165
8166 Example :
8167 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8168 backend private_monitoring
8169 stats enable
8170 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8171 stats uri /admin?stats
8172 stats refresh 5s
8173
8174 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8175 global section.
8176
8177
8178stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008179 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8181 yes | yes | yes | yes
8182 Arguments : none
8183
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008184 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008185 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8186 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8187 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8188 - IP (socket, server)
8189 - cookie (backend, server)
8190
8191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008193 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008194
8195 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8196
8197
8198stats show-node [ <name> ]
8199 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008201 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008202 Arguments:
8203 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8204 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8205
8206 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8207 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008208 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008209
8210 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8211 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8212 unobvious parameters.
8213
8214 Example:
8215 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8216 backend private_monitoring
8217 stats enable
8218 stats show-node Europe-1
8219 stats uri /admin?stats
8220 stats refresh 5s
8221
8222 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8223 section.
8224
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008225
8226stats uri <prefix>
8227 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008229 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008230 Arguments :
8231 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8232 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8233 query string.
8234
8235 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8236 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8237 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8238 possible to reach it in the application.
8239
8240 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008241 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008242 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8243 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8244 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8245 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8246
8247 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8248 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8249 an address or a port to statistics only.
8250
8251 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8252 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8253 unobvious parameters.
8254
8255 Example :
8256 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8257 backend public_www
8258 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8259 stats enable
8260 stats hide-version
8261 stats scope .
8262 stats uri /admin?stats
8263 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8264 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8265 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8266
8267 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8268 backend private_monitoring
8269 stats enable
8270 stats uri /admin?stats
8271 stats refresh 5s
8272
8273 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8274
8275
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008276stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8277 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280
8281 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008282 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008283 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8284 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8285 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8286
8287 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8288 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8289 the "stick-table" statement.
8290
8291 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8292 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8293 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8294 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8295 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8296
8297 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8298 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8299 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8300 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8301 transformation rules.
8302
8303 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8304 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8305 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8306 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8307 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8308 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8309 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8310
8311 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8312 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8313 ACL based conditions.
8314
8315 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8316 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8317 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8318 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8319
8320 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8321 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8322 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8323 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8324
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008325 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8326 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8327 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8328
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008329 Example :
8330 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8331 # last 30 minutes
8332 backend pop
8333 mode tcp
8334 balance roundrobin
8335 stick store-request src
8336 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8337 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8338 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8339
8340 backend smtp
8341 mode tcp
8342 balance roundrobin
8343 stick match src table pop
8344 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8345 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8346
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008347 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008348 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008349
8350
8351stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8352 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8354 no | no | yes | yes
8355
8356 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8357 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8358 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8359 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8360
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008361 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8362 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8363 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8364
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008365 Examples :
8366 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008367 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008368
8369 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8370 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8371 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8372
8373
8374 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8375 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8376 backend http
8377 mode http
8378 balance roundrobin
8379 stick on src table https
8380 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8381 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8382 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8383
8384 backend https
8385 mode tcp
8386 balance roundrobin
8387 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8388 stick on src
8389 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8390 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8391
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008392 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008393
8394
8395stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8396 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 no | no | yes | yes
8399
8400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008401 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008402 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8403 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8404 server is selected.
8405
8406 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8407 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8408 the "stick-table" statement.
8409
8410 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8411 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8412 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8413 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8414 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8415 address.
8416
8417 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8418 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8419 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8420 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8421 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8422 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8423 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8424 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8425 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8426 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8427
8428 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8429 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8430 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8431 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8432 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8433 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8434 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8435
8436 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8437 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8438 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8439 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8440
8441 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8442 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8443 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8444 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8445 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8446 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008447 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8448 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8449 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8450 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8451 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8452 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008453
8454 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8455 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8456 the request.
8457
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008458 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8459 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8460 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8461
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008462 Example :
8463 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8464 # last 30 minutes
8465 backend pop
8466 mode tcp
8467 balance roundrobin
8468 stick store-request src
8469 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8470 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8471 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8472
8473 backend smtp
8474 mode tcp
8475 balance roundrobin
8476 stick match src table pop
8477 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8478 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8479
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008480 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008481 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008482
8483
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008484stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008485 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8486 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008487 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008489 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008490
8491 Arguments :
8492 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8493 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8494 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8495 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8496
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008497 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8498 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8499 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8500 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8501
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008502 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8503 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8504 instance.
8505
8506 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8507 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8508 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8509 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8510 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8511 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008512 to 32 characters.
8513
8514 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8515 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8516 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008517 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008518 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8519 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008520
8521 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008522 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8523 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008524 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8525 increase.
8526
8527 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008528 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8529 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8530 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008531
8532 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8533 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8534 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8535 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8536 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8537 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8538 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8539 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8540 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8541 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8542 parameter (see below).
8543
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008544 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8545 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8546 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8547 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8548 soft restart.
8549
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008550 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8551 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008552
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008553 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8554 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8555 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8556 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008557 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008558 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008559 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8560 if not expiration delay is specified.
8561
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008562 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8563 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8564 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8565 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008566 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8567 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8568 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8569 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8570 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8571 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8572 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8573 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8574 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8575 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8576 types and their arguments.
8577
8578 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8579 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8580 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8581 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8582
8583 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8584 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8585 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8586 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8587
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008588 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8589 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8590 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8591 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8592 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8593 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8594
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008595 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8596 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8597 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8598 they were received.
8599
8600 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8601 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8602 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8603 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8604 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8605
8606 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8607 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8608 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8609 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8610 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8611
8612 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8613 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8614 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8615
8616 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8617 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8618 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8619 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8620 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8621
8622 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8623 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8624 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8625 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8626 the client side.
8627
8628 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8629 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8630 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8631 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8632 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8633 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8634 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8635
8636 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8637 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8638 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8639 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8640 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8641 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8642 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8643
8644 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8645 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8646 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8647 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8648 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8649 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8650
8651 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8652 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8653 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8654 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8655
8656 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8657 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8658 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8659 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8660 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8661 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8662 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8663 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8664 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8665 recommended for better fairness.
8666
8667 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8668 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8669 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8670 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8671
8672 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8673 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8674 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8675 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8676 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8677 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8678 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8679 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8680 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8681 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008682
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008683 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8684 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008685 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8686 reference it.
8687
8688 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8689 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008690 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8691 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8692 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008693
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008694 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8695 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8696 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8697 something that can be ignored.
8698
8699 Example:
8700 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8701 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8702 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8703 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8704
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008705 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008706 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008707
8708
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008709stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008710 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8712 no | no | yes | yes
8713
8714 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008715 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008716 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8717 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8718 server is selected.
8719
8720 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8721 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8722 the "stick-table" statement.
8723
8724 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8725 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8726 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8727 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8728
8729 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8730 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8731 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8732 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8733 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8734 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008735 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008736 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8737 rules.
8738
8739 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8740 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8741 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8742 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8743 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8744 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8745 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8746
8747 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8748 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8749 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8750 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8751
8752 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8753 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8754 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8755 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8756 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8757 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008758 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8759 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8760 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8761 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8762 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8763 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8764 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8765 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8766 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008767
8768 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8769
8770 Example :
8771 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8772 backend https
8773 mode tcp
8774 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008775 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008776 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008777
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008778 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8779 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8780
8781 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8782 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8783 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8784
8785 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8786 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008787
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008788 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8789 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8790 # at offset 44.
8791
8792 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8793 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8794
8795 # Learn on response if server hello.
8796 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008797
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008798 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8799 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8800
8801 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8802 extraction.
8803
8804
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008805tcp-check connect [params*]
8806 Opens a new connection
8807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8808 no | no | yes | yes
8809
8810 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8811 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8812 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8813
8814 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8815 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8816 of the sequence.
8817
8818 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8819 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8820 do.
8821
8822 Parameters :
8823 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8824 use the TCP connection.
8825
8826 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8827 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8828 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8829
8830 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8831
8832 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8833
8834 Examples:
8835 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8836 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8837 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8838 option tcp-check
8839 tcp-check connect
8840 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8841 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8842 tcp-check send \r\n
8843 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8844 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8845 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8846 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8847 tcp-check send \r\n
8848 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8849 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8850
8851 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8852 option tcp-check
8853 tcp-check connect port 110
8854 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8855 tcp-check connect port 143
8856 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8857 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8858
8859 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8860
8861
8862tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8863 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8865 no | no | yes | yes
8866
8867 Arguments :
8868 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8869 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8870 binary.
8871 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8872 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8873 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8874
8875 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8876 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8877 with the usual backslash ('\').
8878 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8879 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8880 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8881 used upper or lower case.
8882
8883
8884 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8885
8886 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8887 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8888 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8889 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8890 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8891 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8892 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8893 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8894
8895 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8896 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8897 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8898 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8899 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8900 expression.
8901
8902 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8903 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8904 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8905 this exact hexadecimal string.
8906 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8907
8908 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8909 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8910 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8911 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8912 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8913 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8914 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8915 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8916 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8917 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8918 the null character.
8919
8920 Examples :
8921 # perform a POP check
8922 option tcp-check
8923 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8924
8925 # perform an IMAP check
8926 option tcp-check
8927 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8928
8929 # look for the redis master server
8930 option tcp-check
8931 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008932 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008933 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8934 tcp-check expect string role:master
8935 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8936 tcp-check expect string +OK
8937
8938
8939 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8940 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8941
8942
8943tcp-check send <data>
8944 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8946 no | no | yes | yes
8947
8948 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8949 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8950
8951 Examples :
8952 # look for the redis master server
8953 option tcp-check
8954 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8955 tcp-check expect string role:master
8956
8957 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8958 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8959
8960
8961tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8962 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8963 tcp health check
8964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8965 no | no | yes | yes
8966
8967 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8968 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8969 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8970 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8971 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8972 hexadecimal string.
8973 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8974
8975 Examples :
8976 # redis check in binary
8977 option tcp-check
8978 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8979 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8980
8981
8982 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8983 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8984
8985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008986tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8987 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008990 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008991 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8992 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008994 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008995
8996 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8997 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008998 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8999 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9000 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9001 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9002 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9003 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009005 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9006 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9007 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9008 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009009
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009010 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009011 - accept :
9012 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9013 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9014 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009016 - reject :
9017 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9018 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9019 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9020 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9021 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9022 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9023 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9024 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9025 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9026 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9027 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009028 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009029
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009030 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9031 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9032 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9033 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9034 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9035 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9036 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9037 hosts.
9038
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009039 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9040 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9041 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9042 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9043 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9044 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9045 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9046 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9047
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009048 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9049 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9050 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9051 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9052 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9053 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9054 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9055 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9056 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009057 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9058 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009059
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009060 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009061 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009062 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009063 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009064 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9065 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009066 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009067 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9068 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9069 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9070 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9071 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009073 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009074 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009075 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009076 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9077 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9078 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9079 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009081 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9082 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9083 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9084 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009086 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9087 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9088 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9089 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9090 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009091 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9092 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9093 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9094 layer7 information is extracted.
9095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009096 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9097 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9098 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9099 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9100 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009101
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009102 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9103 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9104 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9105 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9106
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009107 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9108 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9109 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9110 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9111 continues.
9112
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009113 - set-src <expr> :
9114 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9115 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9116 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9117 set-src"
9118
9119 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9120 followed by some converters.
9121
9122 Example:
9123
9124 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9125
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009126 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9127 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009128
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009129 - set-src-port <expr> :
9130 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9131 expression.
9132
9133 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9134 followed by some converters.
9135
9136 Example:
9137
9138 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9139
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009140 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9141 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9142 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009143
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009144 - set-dst <expr> :
9145 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9146 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9147 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9148 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9149 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9150
9151 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9152 followed by some converters.
9153
9154 Example:
9155
9156 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9157 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9158
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009159 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9160 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9161
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009162 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9163 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9164 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9165 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9166
9167
9168 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9169 followed by some converters.
9170
9171 Example:
9172
9173 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9174
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009175 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9176 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9177 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9178
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009179 - "silent-drop" :
9180 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9181 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9182 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9183 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9184 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9185 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9186 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9187 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9188 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9189 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9190 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9191 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9192 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9193 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9194 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9195 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009197 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9198 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9199 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009201 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9202 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9203 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009206 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009207 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009209 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9210 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9211 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009213 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009214 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9215 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009216
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009217 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9218
9219 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9220
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009221 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9222
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009223 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009224
9225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009226tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9227 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009229 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009231 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9232 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009234 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009236 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9237 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9238 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9239 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9240 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009242 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9243 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9244 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9245 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009246 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9247 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9248 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9249 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9250 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9251 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009252 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009253 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009255 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9256 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9257 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9258 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009259
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009260 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009261 - accept : the request is accepted
9262 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9263 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009264 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009265 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009266 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009267 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009268 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009269 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009270 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009272 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9273 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009274
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009275 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9276 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9277 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9278 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9279 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9280 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009282 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009283 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9284 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009286 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009287 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9288 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9289 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9290 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009291 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9292 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9293 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009294
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009295 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009296 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9297 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9298 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009299
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009300 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009301 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9302 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009303
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009304 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9305 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9308 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009309 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009311 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9313 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009314 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009315 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9316 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009317
9318 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9319 followed by some converters.
9320
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009321 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9322 <var-name>.
9323
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009324 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9325 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9326 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9327 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9328 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9329
9330 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9331
9332 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9333
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009334 Example:
9335
9336 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009337 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009338
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009339 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009340 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9341 # and reject everything else.
9342 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9343 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009344 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009345 tcp-request content reject
9346
9347 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009348 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9349 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9350 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009351 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009352
9353 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9354 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9355 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009356 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009357 tcp-request content reject
9358
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009359 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009360 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009361 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009362 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009363 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9364 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009365
9366 Example:
9367 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9368 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009369 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009371 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009372 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009373
9374 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009375 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009376 # protecting all our sites
9377 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009378 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9379 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009380 ...
9381 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9382
9383 backend http_dynamic
9384 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009385 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009386 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009387 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009388 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009389 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009390 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009393
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009394 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9395 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009396
9397
9398tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9399 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009401 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009402 Arguments :
9403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9405 as explained at the top of this document.
9406
9407 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9408 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9409 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9410 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9411 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9412
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009413 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9414 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9415 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9416 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9417
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009418 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9419 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009420 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009421 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009422 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9423 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9424 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9425 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009426
9427 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9428 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9429 it pass through unaffected.
9430
9431 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9432 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9433 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009434 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009435 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9436 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009437 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9438 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9439 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009441 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009442 "timeout client".
9443
9444
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009445tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9446 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9448 no | no | yes | yes
9449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009450 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9451 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009452
9453 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9454
9455 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9456 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9457 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009458 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9459 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009460
9461 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9462
9463 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9464 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9465 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9466 inserted.
9467
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009468 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009469 - accept :
9470 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9471 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9472 the rules evaluation.
9473
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009474 - close :
9475 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9476 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9477 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9478 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9479 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9480 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009481 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009482 protocols.
9483
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009484 - reject :
9485 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9486 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009487 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009488
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009489 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9490 Sets a variable.
9491
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009492 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9493 Unsets a variable.
9494
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009495 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9496 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9497 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9498 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9499
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009500 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9501 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9502 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9503 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9504 continues.
9505
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009506 - "silent-drop" :
9507 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9508 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9509 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9510 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9511 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9512 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9513 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9514 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9515 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9516 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9517 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9518 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9519 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9520 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9521 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9522 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9523
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009524 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9525 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9526
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009527 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9528 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9529 for changing the default action to a reject.
9530
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009531 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9532 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9533 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9534 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009535 period.
9536
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009537 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9538 declared inline.
9539
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009540 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9541 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009542 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009543 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9544 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009545 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009546 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009547 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009548 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9549 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009550 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009551 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9552 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009553
9554 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9555 followed by some converters.
9556
9557 Example:
9558
9559 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9560
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009561 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9562 <var-name>.
9563
9564 Example:
9565
9566 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9567
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009568 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9569 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9570 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9571 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9572 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9573
9574 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9575
9576 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9577
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009578 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9579
9580 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9581
9582
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009583tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9584 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9586 no | yes | yes | no
9587 Arguments :
9588 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9589 below.
9590
9591 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9592
9593 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9594 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9595 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9596 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9597 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9598 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9599 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9600 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9601 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9602 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9603 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9604 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9605 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9606 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9607 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9608 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9609 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9610 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9611 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9612 instead.
9613
9614 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9615 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9616 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9617 rules which may be inserted.
9618
9619 Several types of actions are supported :
9620 - accept : the request is accepted
9621 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9622 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9623 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9624 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9625 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009626 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009627 - silent-drop
9628
9629 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9630 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9631 sections for a complete description.
9632
9633 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9634 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9635 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9636
9637 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9638 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9639 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9640 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9641 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9642
9643 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9644 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9645
9646 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9647 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9648 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9649
9650 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9651 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9652 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9653
9654 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9655 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9656 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9657
9658 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9659 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9660 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9661
9662 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9663
9664 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9665
9666
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009667tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9670 no | no | yes | yes
9671 Arguments :
9672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9674 as explained at the top of this document.
9675
9676 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9677
9678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009679timeout check <timeout>
9680 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9681 established.
9682
9683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | no | yes | yes
9685 Arguments:
9686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9688 as explained at the top of this document.
9689
9690 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9691 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9692 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9693 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009694 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9695 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9696 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009697
9698 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9699 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9700
9701 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9702 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009703 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009704
9705 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9706 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9707 forget about it.
9708
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009709 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9710 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009711
9712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009713timeout client <timeout>
9714timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9715 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9717 yes | yes | yes | no
9718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009719 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9721 as explained at the top of this document.
9722
9723 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9724 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9725 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009726 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9727 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9728 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9729 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009730 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9731 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9732 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009733 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009734 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009735 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9736 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009737 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9738 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009739
9740 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9741 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9742 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9743 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9744 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9745 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9746
9747 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9748 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9749 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9750
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009751 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9752 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009753
9754
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009755timeout client-fin <timeout>
9756 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9758 yes | yes | yes | no
9759 Arguments :
9760 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9762 as explained at the top of this document.
9763
9764 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9765 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9766 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9767 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9768 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9769 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9770 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9771 down in one direction.
9772
9773 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9774 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9775 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9776
9777 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9778
9779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009780timeout connect <timeout>
9781timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9782 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9784 yes | no | yes | yes
9785 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9788 as explained at the top of this document.
9789
9790 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009791 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009792 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009793 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009794 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9795 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009796
9797 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9798 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9799 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9800 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9801 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9802 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9803
9804 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9805 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9806 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9807
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009808 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9809 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009810
9811
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009812timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9813 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9815 yes | yes | yes | yes
9816 Arguments :
9817 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9818 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9819 as explained at the top of this document.
9820
9821 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9822 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9823 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9824 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9825 once the request has started to present itself.
9826
9827 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9828 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9829 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9830 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9831 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9832
9833 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9834 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9835 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9836 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9837
9838 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9839 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9840 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9841 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9842 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009843 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009844
9845 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9846 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9847 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9848 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9849
9850 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9851
9852
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009853timeout http-request <timeout>
9854 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009857 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9860 as explained at the top of this document.
9861
9862 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9863 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9864 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9865 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9866 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9867 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9868 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009869 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9870 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9871 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9872 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9873 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009874 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9875 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009876
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009877 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9878 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9879 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9880 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9881 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009882 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009883
9884 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9885 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9886 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9887 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9888 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9889
9890 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009891 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9892 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9893 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009894
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009895 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009896 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009897
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009898
9899timeout queue <timeout>
9900 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9902 yes | no | yes | yes
9903 Arguments :
9904 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9905 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9906 as explained at the top of this document.
9907
9908 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9909 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9910 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9911 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9912 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9913
9914 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9915 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9916 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9917 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9918
9919 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9920
9921
9922timeout server <timeout>
9923timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9924 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9926 yes | no | yes | yes
9927 Arguments :
9928 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9930 as explained at the top of this document.
9931
9932 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9933 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9934 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9935 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9936 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9937 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9938 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9939
9940 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9941 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9942 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9943 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9944 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009945 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009946 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009947 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9948 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9949 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9950 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009951
9952 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9953 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9954 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9955 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9956 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9957 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9958
9959 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9960 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9961 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9962
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009963 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009965
9966timeout server-fin <timeout>
9967 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9969 yes | no | yes | yes
9970 Arguments :
9971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9973 as explained at the top of this document.
9974
9975 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9976 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9977 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9978 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9979 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9980 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9981 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9982 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9983 situations, it should not be needed.
9984
9985 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9986 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9987 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9988
9989 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9990
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009991
9992timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009993 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 yes | yes | yes | yes
9996 Arguments :
9997 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9998 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9999 as explained at the top of this document.
10000
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010001 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10002 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10003 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10004 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010005
10006 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10007 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10008 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10009 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010010 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010011
10012 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10013
10014
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010015timeout tunnel <timeout>
10016 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10018 yes | no | yes | yes
10019 Arguments :
10020 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10022 as explained at the top of this document.
10023
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010024 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010025 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10026 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10027 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10028 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10029 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10030 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10031 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10032 specified.
10033
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010034 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10035 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10036 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10037 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10038 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10039 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10040 state.
10041
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010042 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10043 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10044 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10045 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10046 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10047
10048 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10049 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10050 forget about it.
10051
10052 Example :
10053 defaults http
10054 option http-server-close
10055 timeout connect 5s
10056 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010057 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010058 timeout server 30s
10059 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10060
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010061 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010062
10063
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010064transparent (deprecated)
10065 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010067 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010068 Arguments : none
10069
10070 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10071 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10072 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10073 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10074 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10075 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10076 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10077 appropriate server.
10078
10079 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10080
10081 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10082 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10083
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010084 See also: "option transparent"
10085
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010086unique-id-format <string>
10087 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10089 yes | yes | yes | no
10090 Arguments :
10091 <string> is a log-format string.
10092
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010093 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10094 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10095 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10096 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010097
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010098 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10099 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10100 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10101 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10102 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10103 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10104 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10105 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010106
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010107 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10108 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010109
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010110 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010111
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010112 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010113
10114 will generate:
10115
10116 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10117
10118 See also: "unique-id-header"
10119
10120unique-id-header <name>
10121 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10123 yes | yes | yes | no
10124 Arguments :
10125 <name> is the name of the header.
10126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010127 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10128 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010129
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010130 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010131
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010132 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010133 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10134
10135 will generate:
10136
10137 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10138
10139 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010140
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010141use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010142 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10144 no | yes | yes | no
10145 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010146 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10147 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010148
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010149 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10150 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010151
10152 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10153 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10154 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010155 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10156 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10157 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10158 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010159
10160 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10161 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10162 assign the backend.
10163
10164 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10165 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10166 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10167 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10168 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10169 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10170
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010171 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010172 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010173 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10174 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10175 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10176
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010177 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10178 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10179 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10180 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10181 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10182 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10183 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10184 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10185 cannot be forced from the request.
10186
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010187 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010188 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10189 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10190
10191 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10192 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010193
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010194
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010195use-server <server> if <condition>
10196use-server <server> unless <condition>
10197 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10199 no | no | yes | yes
10200 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010201 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010202
10203 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10204
10205 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10206 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10207 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10208
10209 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10210 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10211 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10212 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10213 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10214 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10215 matches will assign the server.
10216
10217 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10218 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10219 with the next rules until one matches.
10220
10221 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10222 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10223 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10224 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10225
10226 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10227 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10228 stripped.
10229
10230 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10231 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10232 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10233 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10234
10235 Example :
10236 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10237 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10238 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10239 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10240 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10241 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010242 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010243 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10244 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010246 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010247
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010248
102495. Bind and Server options
10250--------------------------
10251
10252The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10253depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10254settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10255written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10256described in this section.
10257
10258
102595.1. Bind options
10260-----------------
10261
10262The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10263as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10264no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10265parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10266while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10267provided immediately after the setting name.
10268
10269The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10270
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010271accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10272 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10273 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10274 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10275 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10276 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10277 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10278 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10279 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10280 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010281 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10282 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10283 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010284
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010285accept-proxy
10286 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010287 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10288 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010289 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10290 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10291 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10292 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10293 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10294 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10295 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010296 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10297 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010298
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010299allow-0rtt
10300 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10301 due to security considerations.
10302
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010303alpn <protocols>
10304 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10305 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10306 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10307 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10308 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10309 initial NPN extension.
10310
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010311backlog <backlog>
10312 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10313 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10314
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010315curves <curves>
10316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10317 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10318 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10319 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10320 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10321 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10322
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010323ecdhe <named curve>
10324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010325 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10326 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010327
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010328ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10330 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10331 client's certificate.
10332
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010333ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10335 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10336 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10337 error is ignored.
10338
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010339ca-sign-file <cafile>
10340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10341 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10342 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10343 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10344 'generate-certificates' for details.
10345
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010346ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10348 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10349 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10350 'generate-certificates' for details.
10351
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010352ciphers <ciphers>
10353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10354 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010355 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010356 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10357 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010358 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10359 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10360 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10361 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010362
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010363crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10365 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10366 to verify client's certificate.
10367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010368crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10370 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10371 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10372 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10373 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10374 file.
10375
10376 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10377 are loaded.
10378
10379 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010380 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010381 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10382 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10383 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10384 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10385 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10386 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10387 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010388
10389 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10390 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10391 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10392 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010393 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10394 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010395
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010396 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010397
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010398 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10399 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010400 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010401 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10402 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10403 clients).
10404
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010405 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10406 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10407 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10408 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10409 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10410 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10411 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10412 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10413 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10414 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10415 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10416 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10417 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10418
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010419 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10420 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10421 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10422 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10423 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10424
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010425 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10426 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10427 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10428 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010429
10430 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10431 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10432 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10433 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10434 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10435 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10436 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10437 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10438 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10439
10440 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10441
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010442 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010443 a cert bundle.
10444
10445 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10446 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10447 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10448 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10449 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10450 provide multi-cert support.
10451
10452 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10453
10454 Filename | CN | SAN
10455 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10456 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010457 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010458 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10459 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10460
10461 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10462 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10463 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10464 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010465 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10466 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10467 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010468
10469 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10470 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10471
10472 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10473 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10474 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10475
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010476crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10478 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010479 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010480 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010481
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010482crt-list <file>
10483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010484 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10485 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010486
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010487 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10488
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010489 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10490 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010491 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010492 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010493
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010494 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10495 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10496 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10497 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10498 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10499 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10500 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10501 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010502
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010503 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010504 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010505 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10506 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10507 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010508
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010509 crt-list file example:
10510 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010511 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010512 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010513 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010514
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010515defer-accept
10516 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10517 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10518 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10519 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10520 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10521 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10522 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10523 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10524 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10525 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10526 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10527
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010528expose-fd listeners
10529 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10530 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010531 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10532 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010533 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10534
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010535force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010536 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010537 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010538 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010539 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010540
10541force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010542 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010543 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010544 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010545
10546force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010547 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010548 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010549 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010550
10551force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010552 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010553 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010554 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010555
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010556force-tlsv13
10557 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10558 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010559 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010560
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010561generate-certificates
10562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10563 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10564 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10565 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10566 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10567 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10568 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10569 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10570 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10571 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10572 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10573
10574 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10575 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10576 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10577 certificate is used many times.
10578
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010579gid <gid>
10580 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10581 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10582 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10583 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10584 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10585
10586group <group>
10587 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10588 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10589 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10590 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10591 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10592
10593id <id>
10594 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10595 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10596 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10597 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10598
10599interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010600 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10601 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10602 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10603 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10604 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10605 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10606 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010607
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010608level <level>
10609 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10610 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10611 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10612 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10613 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10614 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10615 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10616 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10617 counters).
10618 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10619 all counters).
10620
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010621severity-output <format>
10622 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10623 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10624 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10625 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10626 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10627 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10628 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10629 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10630 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10631 rfc5424 convention.
10632
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010633maxconn <maxconn>
10634 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10635 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10636 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10637 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10638 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10639 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10640 eat all memory.
10641
10642mode <mode>
10643 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10644 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10645 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10646 UNIX sockets.
10647
10648mss <maxseg>
10649 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10650 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10651 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10652 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10653 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10654 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10655 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10656 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10657 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10658 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10659 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10660
10661name <name>
10662 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10663 page.
10664
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010665namespace <name>
10666 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10667 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10668 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10669 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010671nice <nice>
10672 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10673 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10674 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10675 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10676 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10677 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10678 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10679 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10680 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10681 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10682 one for an RDP socket.
10683
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010684no-ca-names
10685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10686 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10687
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010688no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010690 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010691 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010692 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010693 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10694 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010695
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010696no-tls-tickets
10697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10698 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10699 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010700 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10701 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010702
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010703no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010705 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010706 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010707 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010708 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10709 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010710
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010711no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010713 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010714 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010715 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010716 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10717 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010718
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010719no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010721 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010722 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010723 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010724 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10725 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010726
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010727no-tlsv13
10728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10729 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10730 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10731 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010732 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10733 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010734
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010735npn <protocols>
10736 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10737 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10738 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10739 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010740 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10741 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010742
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010743prefer-client-ciphers
10744 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10745 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10746 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10747
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010748process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10749 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10750 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10751 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10752 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10753 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10754 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10755 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010756 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10757 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10758 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10759 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10760 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10761 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10762 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010764ssl
10765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010766 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010767 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10768 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010769 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10770 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010771
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010772ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10773 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10774 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10775 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10776
10777ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10778 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10779 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10780 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10781
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010782strict-sni
10783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10784 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10785 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10786 See the "crt" option for more information.
10787
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010788tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010789 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010790 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10791 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010792 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010793 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10794 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10795 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10796 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10797 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10798 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10799 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10800
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010801tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010802 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010803 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10804 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10805 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10806 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10807 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10808 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10809 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010810 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10811 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10812 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010813
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010814tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10815 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10816 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10817 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10818 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10819 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10820 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10821 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10822 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10823 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10824 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10825
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010826transparent
10827 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10828 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10829 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10830 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10831 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10832 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10833 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10834 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10835 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10836 so check for support with your vendor.
10837
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010838v4v6
10839 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10840 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10841 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10842 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010843 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010844
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010845v6only
10846 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10847 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10848 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010849 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10850 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010852uid <uid>
10853 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10854 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10855 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10856 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10857 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10858
10859user <user>
10860 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10861 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10862 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10863 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10864 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10865
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010866verify [none|optional|required]
10867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10868 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10869 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10870 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10871 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010872 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10873 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10874 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10875 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010876
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200108775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010878------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010880The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10881which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10882arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10883settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10884after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10885Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10886address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010888 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010889 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010890
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010891Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10892keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010894The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010895
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010896addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010897 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010898 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10899 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10900 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10901 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10902 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010903
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010904agent-check
10905 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010906 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10907 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10908 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10909 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010910
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010911 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010912 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010913 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10914 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10915 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010916
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010917 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10918 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10919 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10920 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10921 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10922
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010923 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10924 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010925
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010926 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10927 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10928 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010929
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010930 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10931 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10932 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010933
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010934 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10935 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10936 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10937 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10938 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10939 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10940 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010941
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010942 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10943 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010944
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010945 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10946 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10947 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10948 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10949 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10950 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10951 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10952 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10953 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010954
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010955 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10956 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010957 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10958 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10959 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010960 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010961
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010962 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010963 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010964
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010965agent-send <string>
10966 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10967 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10968 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10969 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10970 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10971
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010972agent-inter <delay>
10973 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10974 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10975
10976 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10977 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10978 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10979 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10980 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10981 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10982 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10983 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10984 of backends use the same servers.
10985
10986 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10987
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010988agent-addr <addr>
10989 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10990
10991 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10992 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10993 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10994 hostname, it will be resolved.
10995
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010996agent-port <port>
10997 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10998
10999 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011001backup
11002 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11003 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11004 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11005 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011006 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11007 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011008
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011009ca-file <cafile>
11010 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11011 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11012 server's certificate.
11013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011014check
11015 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011016 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11017 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11018 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11019 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11020 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11021 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11022 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011023 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11024 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011025 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11026 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011027
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011028check-send-proxy
11029 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11030 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11031 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11032 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11033 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11034 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11035 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11036
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011037check-sni
11038 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11039 over SSL.
11040
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011041check-ssl
11042 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11043 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11044 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11045 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011046 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011047 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11048 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11049 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011050 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11051 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011052
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011053ciphers <ciphers>
11054 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011055 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011056 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11057 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11058 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11059 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11060 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11061 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063cookie <value>
11064 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11065 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11066 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11067 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11068 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11069 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11070 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11071
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011072crl-file <crlfile>
11073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11074 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11075 to verify server's certificate.
11076
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011077crt <cert>
11078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11079 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11080 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11081 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11082 certificate request.
11083
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011084disabled
11085 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11086 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11087 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11088 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11089 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011090 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011092enabled
11093 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11094 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11095 default value.
11096 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11097 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011099error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011100 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11101 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11102 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011104 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011106fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011107 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11108 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11109 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11110
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011111force-sslv3
11112 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11113 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011114 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011115 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011116
11117force-tlsv10
11118 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011119 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011120 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011121
11122force-tlsv11
11123 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011124 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011125 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011126
11127force-tlsv12
11128 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011129 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011130 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011131
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011132force-tlsv13
11133 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11134 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011135 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011137id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011138 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11139 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11140 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011141
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011142init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11143 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11144 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11145 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11146 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11147 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11148 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11149 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11150 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11151 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11152 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11153 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11154 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11155 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11156 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11157 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11158 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11159 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11160 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11161 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11162 historic behaviour.
11163
11164 Example:
11165 defaults
11166 # never fail on address resolution
11167 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011169inter <delay>
11170fastinter <delay>
11171downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011172 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11173 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11174 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11175 between checks depending on the server state :
11176
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011177 Server state | Interval used
11178 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11179 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11180 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11181 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11182 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11183 or yet unchecked. |
11184 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11185 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11186 | "inter" otherwise.
11187 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011189 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11190 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11191 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11192 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011193 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11194 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11195 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11196 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11197 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011199maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011200 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11201 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11202 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11203 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11204 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11205 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11206 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11207 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011209maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011210 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11211 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11212 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11213 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11214 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11215 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11216 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011218minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011219 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11220 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11221 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11222 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11223 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11224 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011225 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011226 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011227
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011228namespace <name>
11229 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11230 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11231 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11232 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11233
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011234no-agent-check
11235 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11236 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11237 default value.
11238 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11239 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11240
11241no-backup
11242 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11243 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11244 default value.
11245 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11246 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11247
11248no-check
11249 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11250 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11251 default value.
11252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11253 "default-server" "check" setting.
11254
11255no-check-ssl
11256 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11257 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11258 default value.
11259 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11260 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11261
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011262no-send-proxy
11263 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11264 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11265 default value.
11266 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11267 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11268
11269no-send-proxy-v2
11270 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11271 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11272 default value.
11273 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11274 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11275
11276no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11277 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11278 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11279 default value.
11280 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11281 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11282
11283no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11284 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11285 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11286 default value.
11287 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11288 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11289
11290no-ssl
11291 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11292 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11293 default value.
11294 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11295 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11296
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011297no-ssl-reuse
11298 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11299 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11300 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11301 and for paranoid users.
11302
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011303no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011304 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11305 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011306 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011307
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011308 Supported in default-server: No
11309
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011310no-tls-tickets
11311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11312 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11313 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011314 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11315 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011316 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011317
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011318no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011319 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011320 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11321 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011322 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11323 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011324 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011325
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011326 Supported in default-server: No
11327
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011328no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011329 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011330 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11331 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011332 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11333 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011334 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011335
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011336 Supported in default-server: No
11337
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011338no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011339 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011340 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11341 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011342 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11343 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011344 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011345
11346 Supported in default-server: No
11347
11348no-tlsv13
11349 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11350 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11351 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11352 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11353 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011354 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011355
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011356 Supported in default-server: No
11357
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011358no-verifyhost
11359 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11360 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11361 default value.
11362 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11363 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011364
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011365non-stick
11366 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11367 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11368 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011370observe <mode>
11371 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11372 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11373 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11374 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11375 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11376 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011377 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011378
11379 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011381on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011382 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11383 Currently, four modes are available:
11384 - fastinter: force fastinter
11385 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11386 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11387 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11388 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11389
11390 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11391
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011392on-marked-down <action>
11393 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11394 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011395 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11396 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11397 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11398 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11399 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11400 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11401 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11402 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011403
11404 Actions are disabled by default
11405
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011406on-marked-up <action>
11407 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11408 Currently one action is available:
11409 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11410 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11411 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11412 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11413 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11414 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11415 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11416 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11417
11418 Actions are disabled by default
11419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011420port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011421 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11422 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11423 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11424 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11425 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11426 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11427
11428redir <prefix>
11429 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11430 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11431 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11432 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11433 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11434 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11435 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11436 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011437 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011438 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11439 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11440 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11441 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11442 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11443
11444 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011446rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011447 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11448 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11449 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11450
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011451resolve-prefer <family>
11452 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11453 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11454 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11455 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11456
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011457 Default value: ipv6
11458
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011459 Example:
11460
11461 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011462
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011463resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11464 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11465 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011466 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011467 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11468 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11469 configured network, another address is selected.
11470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011471 Example:
11472
11473 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011474
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011475resolvers <id>
11476 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11477 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011478 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11479 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11480 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11481 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011482
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011483 Example:
11484
11485 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011486
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011487 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011488
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011489send-proxy
11490 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11491 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11492 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11493 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011494 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11495 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11496 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11497 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11498 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11499 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11500 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11501 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11502 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11503 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011504 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11505 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011506
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011507send-proxy-v2
11508 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11509 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11510 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11511 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011512 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11513 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11514 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11515 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011516
11517send-proxy-v2-ssl
11518 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11519 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11520 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11521 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11522 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11523 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11524 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011525 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11526 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011527
11528send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11529 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11530 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11531 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11532 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11533 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11534 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11535 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11536 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011537 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11538 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011540slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011541 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11542 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11543 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11544 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11545 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11546 parameters :
11547
11548 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11549 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11550
11551 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11552 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11553 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11554 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11555
11556 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11557 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11558 seen as failed.
11559
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011560sni <expression>
11561 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11562 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11563 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11564 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011565 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11566 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011567 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11568 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011569
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011570source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011571source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011572source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011573 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11574 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11575 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11576 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11577
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011578 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11579 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11580 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11581 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11582 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11583 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11584 server.
11585
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011586 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11587 specifying the source address without port(s).
11588
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011589ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011590 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11591 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11592 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11593 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11594 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11595 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011596 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11597 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011598
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011599ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11600 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11601 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11602 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11603
11604ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11605 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11606 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11607 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11608
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011609ssl-reuse
11610 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11611 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11612 default value.
11613 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11614 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11615
11616stick
11617 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11618 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11619 default value.
11620 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11621 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011622
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011623tcp-ut <delay>
11624 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11625 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11626 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011627 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011628 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11629 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11630 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11631 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11632 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11633 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11634 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11635 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11636 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011638track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011639 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11640 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11641 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11642 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011643 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11644
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011645tls-tickets
11646 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11647 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11648 default value.
11649 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11650 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011651
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011652verify [none|required]
11653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011654 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011655 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11656 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11657 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11658 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11659 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11660 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11661 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11662 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11663 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11664 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11665 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011666
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011667verifyhost <hostname>
11668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011669 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11670 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11671 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11672 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11673 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11674 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11675 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11676 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011678weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011679 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11680 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11681 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011682 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11683 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11684 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11685 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11686 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11687 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011688
11689
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116905.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11691-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011692
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011693HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11694using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11695configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011696This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11697can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11698workload.
11699This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11700resolution at run time.
11701Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11702carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11703
11704
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117055.3.1. Global overview
11706----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011707
11708As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11709different steps of the process life:
11710
11711 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11712 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11713 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11714
11715 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11716 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11717 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11718
11719A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11720 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11721 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11722 resolution to know this new IP.
11723
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011724When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or s SRV label.
11725HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore a SRV label.
11726If a SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be
11727retrieved from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The
11728SRV label will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed,
11729haproxy will automatically do the same.
11730
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011731A few things important to notice:
11732 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11733 first valid response.
11734
11735 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11736 servers return an error.
11737
11738
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117395.3.2. The resolvers section
11740----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011741
11742This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11743HAProxy.
11744There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11745many name servers.
11746
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011747When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11748uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11749is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11750answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11751
11752When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11753used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11754
11755Two types of behavior can be applied:
11756 1. stop DNS resolution
11757 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11758 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11759 1. ANY query type
11760 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11761 server's parameter
11762 3. remaining family type
11763
11764HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11765 - invalid DNS response packet
11766 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11767 - NX domain
11768 - Query refused by server
11769 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11770
11771HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11772 - no Answer records in the response
11773 - DNS response truncated
11774 - Error in DNS response
11775 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11776 - name server timeout
11777
11778For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11779 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11780 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11781 applied;
11782 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11783 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11784 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11785 stops resolution.
11786
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011787As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11788a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
11789"hold obsolete" seconds without the IP returned.
11790
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011791
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011792resolvers <resolvers id>
11793 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11794
11795A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11796
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011797accepted_payload_size <nb>
11798 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
11799 naeservers configured in this resolvers section.
11800 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11801 by RFC 6891)
11802
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011803 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011804 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11805
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011806 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11807
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011808nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11809 DNS server description:
11810 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11811 <ip> : IP address of the server
11812 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11813
11814hold <status> <period>
11815 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11816 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011817 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011818 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011819 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11820 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11821 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11822
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011823 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011824
11825 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11826 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11827 the healch check.
11828
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011829resolution_pool_size <nb>
11830 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11831 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11832 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11833
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011834resolve_retries <nb>
11835 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11836 giving up.
11837 Default value: 3
11838
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011839 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11840 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11841 type.
11842
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011843timeout <event> <time>
11844 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11845 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11846 events available are:
11847 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11848 been received.
11849 Default value: 1s
11850 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11851 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11852
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011853 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011854
11855 resolvers mydns
11856 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11857 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11858 resolve_retries 3
11859 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011860 hold other 30s
11861 hold refused 30s
11862 hold nx 30s
11863 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011864 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011865 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011866
11867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118686. HTTP header manipulation
11869---------------------------
11870
11871In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11872response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11873request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11874which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011875against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011876
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011877If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11878to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11879but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11880HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11881stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11882because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11883a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11884still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011886This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11887in section 4.2 :
11888
11889 - reqadd <string>
11890 - reqallow <search>
11891 - reqiallow <search>
11892 - reqdel <search>
11893 - reqidel <search>
11894 - reqdeny <search>
11895 - reqideny <search>
11896 - reqpass <search>
11897 - reqipass <search>
11898 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11899 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11900 - reqtarpit <search>
11901 - reqitarpit <search>
11902 - rspadd <string>
11903 - rspdel <search>
11904 - rspidel <search>
11905 - rspdeny <search>
11906 - rspideny <search>
11907 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11908 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11909
11910With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11911is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11912parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11913prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11914Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11915
11916 \t for a tab
11917 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11918 \n for a new line (LF)
11919 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11920 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11921 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11922 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11923 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11924
11925The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11926portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11927above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11928regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119299 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11930is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11931
11932The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11933after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11934
11935Notes related to these keywords :
11936---------------------------------
11937 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11938 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11939 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11940
11941 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11942 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11943 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11944
11945 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11946 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11947 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11948 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11949 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11950
11951 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11952 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11953 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11954 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11955 useless headers before adding new ones.
11956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011957 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011958 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11959
11960 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11961 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11962 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11963
11964 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11965 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011966 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011967
11968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11970----------------------------------
11971
11972Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11973client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11974The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11975these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11976but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11977data called patterns.
11978
11979
119807.1. ACL basics
11981---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011982
11983The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11984content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11985from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11986simple :
11987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011989 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011990 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11991 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11994adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011995
11996In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011998 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011999
12000This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12001Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12002and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012003an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12004conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12005as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12006are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012007
12008ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12009'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12010which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12011
12012There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12013performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12016specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12017this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012018methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12019ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020
12021Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12022 - boolean
12023 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12024 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12025 - string
12026 - data block
12027
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012028Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12029converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12030would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12031The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12032which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12033
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012034Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12035keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12036fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12037which are summarized in the table below :
12038
12039 +---------------------+-----------------+
12040 | Sample or converter | Default |
12041 | output type | matching method |
12042 +---------------------+-----------------+
12043 | boolean | bool |
12044 +---------------------+-----------------+
12045 | integer | int |
12046 +---------------------+-----------------+
12047 | ip | ip |
12048 +---------------------+-----------------+
12049 | string | str |
12050 +---------------------+-----------------+
12051 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12052 +---------------------+-----------------+
12053
12054Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12055matching method, see below.
12056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012057The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12058 - boolean
12059 - integer or integer range
12060 - IP address / network
12061 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12062 - regular expression
12063 - hex block
12064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012065The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12066
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012067 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12068 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012069 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012070 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012071 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012072 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012073 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012075The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12076read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12077if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12078lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12079will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12080beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12081a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12082lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12083exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12084
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012085The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12086parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12087ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12088a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12089check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12090
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012091The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12092socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12093file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12096loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12097
12098 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12099
12100In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12101the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12102case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12103as well.
12104
12105The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12106sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12107do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12108methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12109is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12110obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12111followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12112default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12113that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12114string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12115
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012116The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12117By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12118string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12119resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12120server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12121waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12122flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12123function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12126sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12127be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012128
12129 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12130 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012131 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12132 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12133 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12134 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012135
12136 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12137 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012139
12140 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012141 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012142
12143 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012144 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012145
12146 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12147 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12148
12149 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12150 binary or string samples.
12151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12153 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12156 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12157 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012159 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12160 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012162 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12163 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012165 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12166 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012168 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12169 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012170 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012172 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12173 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12174 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012175
12176For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12177request, it is possible to do :
12178
12179 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12180
12181In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12182buffer, one would use the following acl :
12183
12184 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12185
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012186On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12187possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12188
12189 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012191All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12192criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12193method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12194to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12195criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12196the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012198If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012199the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12200For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012202 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12203 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12204 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12205 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012206
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012207
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012208The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12209types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12210combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12211brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12212default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012214 +-------------------------------------------------+
12215 | Input sample type |
12216 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012217 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012218 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12219 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12220 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012221 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012222 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012223 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012224 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012225 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012226 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012227 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012228 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012229 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012230 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012231 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012233 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012234 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012235 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012236 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012237 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012239 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012241 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12243 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12244 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012245
12246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122477.1.1. Matching booleans
12248------------------------
12249
12250In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12251Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12252When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12253that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12254
12255Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12256return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12257"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12258
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122607.1.2. Matching integers
12261------------------------
12262
12263Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12264enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12265to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12266
12267Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12268matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12269lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012270
12271For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12272unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12273representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12274
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012275As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12276two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12277instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12278ranges and operators.
12279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012280For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012281operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12282Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12283of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012285Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012286
12287 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12288 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12289 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12290 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12291 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012293For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012294
12295 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12296
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012297This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12298
12299 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123027.1.3. Matching strings
12303-----------------------
12304
12305String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12306different forms :
12307
12308 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12309 patterns ;
12310
12311 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12312 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12313
12314 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12315 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12316
12317 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12318 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12319
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012320 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012321 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12322 matches.
12323
12324 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12325 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12326 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012327
12328String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12329exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12330characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12331string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12332to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012333before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012334
12335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123367.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12337---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012338
12339Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12340they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12341possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12342passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12343the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012344the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12345match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012346
12347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123487.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12349-------------------------------------
12350
12351It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12352not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12353a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12354to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12355digits may be used upper or lower case.
12356
12357Example :
12358 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12359 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12360
12361
123627.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12363---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012364
12365IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12366netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12367within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012368host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012369difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12370at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12371does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12372parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012373
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012374The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12375abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12376
12377 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12378 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12379 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12380 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12381 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12382 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12383 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12384 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12385
12386Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12387192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12388
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012389IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12390Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12391trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12392IPv6 patterns.
12393
12394HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12395following situations :
12396 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12397 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12398 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12399 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12400 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12401 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12402 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12403 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12404 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12405 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407
124087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12409----------------------------------
12410
12411Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12412combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12413
12414 - AND (implicit)
12415 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12416 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012418A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012422Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12423indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12426"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12427requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12428is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12429
12430 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012431 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12432 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12433 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434
12435To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12436and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12437
12438 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12439 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12440 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12441 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12442
12443 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12444 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12445 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12446 use_backend www if host_www
12447
12448It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12449expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12450be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12451the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12452
12453 The following rule :
12454
12455 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012456 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012457
12458 Can also be written that way :
12459
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012460 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461
12462It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12463to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12464simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12465sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12466good use is the following :
12467
12468 With named ACLs :
12469
12470 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12471 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12472 monitor fail if site_dead
12473
12474 With anonymous ACLs :
12475
12476 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12477
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012478See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12479keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480
12481
124827.3. Fetching samples
12483---------------------
12484
12485Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12486against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12487sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12488ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12489of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12490available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12491
12492This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12493Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12494compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12495deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12496
12497The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12498matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12499method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12500indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12501
12502As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12503when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12504mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12505the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12506ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12507
12508Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12509multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12510when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12511incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12512are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12513is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12514all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12515
12516Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12517 - name
12518 - name(arg1)
12519 - name(arg1,arg2)
12520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012521
125227.3.1. Converters
12523-----------------
12524
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012525Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12526of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12527is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12528was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12529has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12530unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12531
12532These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12533sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12534the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12535support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012536
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012537A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12538support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12539supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12540(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12541bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012544
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001254551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12546 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12547 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12548 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12549 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12550 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12551
12552 Example :
12553 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12554 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12555 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12556 frontend http-in
12557 bind *:8081
12558 default_backend servers
12559 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12560 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12561
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012562add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012563 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012564 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012565 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12566 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012567 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012568 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12569 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12570 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12571 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12572 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012573 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012574
12575and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012576 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012577 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012578 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12579 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012580 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012581 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12582 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12583 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12584 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12585 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012586 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012587
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012588b64dec
12589 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12590 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12591
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012592base64
12593 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12594 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12595 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12596
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012597bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012598 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012599 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12600 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12601 presence of a flag).
12602
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012603bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12604 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12605 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012606 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012608cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012609 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12610 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012611
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012612crc32([<avalanche>])
12613 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12614 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12615 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12616 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12617 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12618 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12619 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12620 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12621 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12622 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12623 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12624
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012625da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012626 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12627 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12628 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12629 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012630 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012631 configuration language.
12632
12633 Example:
12634 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012635 bind *:8881
12636 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012637 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012638
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012639debug
12640 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12641 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12642 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12643
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012644div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012645 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12646 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012647 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012648 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12649 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012650 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012651 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12652 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12653 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12654 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012656 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012657
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012658djb2([<avalanche>])
12659 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12660 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12661 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12662 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12663 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12664 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12665 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012666 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12667 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012668
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012669even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012670 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012671 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12672
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012673field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12674 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12675 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12676 list of chars.
12677
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012678hex
12679 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12680 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12681 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12682 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012683
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012684hex2i
12685 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12686 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12687
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012688http_date([<offset>])
12689 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12690 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12691 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12692 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12693 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12694 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012696in_table(<table>)
12697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12699 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12700 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12701 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12702
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012703ipmask(<mask>)
12704 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12705 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12706 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12707 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12708
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012709json([<input-code>])
12710 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12711 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012712 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012713 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12714 of errors:
12715 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12716 bytes, ...)
12717 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12718 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12719
12720 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12721 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12722 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12723 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12724 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12725 are :
12726 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12727 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12728 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12729 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12730 error ;
12731 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12732 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12733
12734 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12735 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12736
12737 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012738 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012739 capture request header user-agent len 150
12740 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012741
12742 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12743 GET / HTTP/1.0
12744 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12745
12746 Output log:
12747 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12748
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012749language(<value>[,<default>])
12750 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12751 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12752 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12753 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12754 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12755 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12756 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12757 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12758 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12759 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12760 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12761 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012763 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012764
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012765 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12766 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012767
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012768 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12769 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12770 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12771 use_backend spanish if es
12772 use_backend french if fr
12773 use_backend english if en
12774 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012775
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012776lower
12777 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12778 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12779 type. The result is of type string.
12780
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012781ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12782 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12783 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12784 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12785 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12786 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12787 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12788
12789 Example :
12790
12791 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12792 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12793 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12794
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012795map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12796map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12797map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12798 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12799 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12800 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12801 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12802 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12803 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12804 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12805 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012806
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012807 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12808 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12809 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012810
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012811 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012812 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012813
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012814 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12816 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012818 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012820 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12822 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12824 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12826 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12827 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012828 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12829 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12830 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012831 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12832 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12833 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12834 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12835 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012836
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012837 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12838 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12839 the corresponding match text.
12840
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012841 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12842 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12843 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12844 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12845 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012846
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012847 Example :
12848
12849 # this is a comment and is ignored
12850 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12851 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12852 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12853 | | | `---------- value
12854 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12855 | `---------------------------- key
12856 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012858mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012859 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12860 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012861 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012862 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012863 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012864 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12865 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12866 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12867 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012869 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012870
12871mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012872 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012873 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12874 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012875 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012876 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012877 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012878 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12879 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12880 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12881 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12882 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012883 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012884
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012885nbsrv
12886 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12887 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12888 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12889 map lookup.
12890
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012891neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012892 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12893 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12894 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12895 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012896
12897not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012898 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012899 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12900 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12901 absence of a flag).
12902
12903odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012904 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012905 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12906
12907or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012908 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012909 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012910 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12911 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012912 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012913 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12914 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12915 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12916 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012918 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012919
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012920regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012921 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12922 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12923 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12924 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12925 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12926 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12927 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12928 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12929 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12930 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012931 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12932 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12933 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12934 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012935
12936 Example :
12937
12938 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12939 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12940 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12941 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12942
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012943capture-req(<id>)
12944 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12945 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12946
12947 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012948 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12949 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012950
12951capture-res(<id>)
12952 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12953 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12954
12955 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012956 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12957 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012958
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012959sdbm([<avalanche>])
12960 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12961 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12962 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12963 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12964 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12965 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12966 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012967 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12968 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012970set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012971 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12972 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12973 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012974 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012975 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12976 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012977 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012978 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12979 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012981 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012982
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020012983sha1
12984 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
12985 sample with length of 20 bytes.
12986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012987sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012988 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12989 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012990 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012991 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12992 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012993 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012994 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12995 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012996 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012997 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12998 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012999 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013000 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013001
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013002table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13003 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13004 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13005 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13006 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13007 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13008 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13009
13010
13011table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13015 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13016 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13017 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13018
13019table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13023 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13024 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13025
13026table_conn_cur(<table>)
13027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13030 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13031 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13032
13033table_conn_rate(<table>)
13034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13037 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13038 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13039
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013040table_gpt0(<table>)
13041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13044 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13045 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13046
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013047table_gpc0(<table>)
13048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13051 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13052 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13053
13054table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13058 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13059 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13060 sample fetch keyword.
13061
13062table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13065 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13066 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13067 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13068
13069table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13072 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13073 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13074 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13075 keyword.
13076
13077table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13081 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13082 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13083
13084table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13087 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13088 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13089 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13090 keyword.
13091
13092table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13096 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13097 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13098 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13099 keyword.
13100
13101table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13105 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13106 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13107 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13108 keyword.
13109
13110table_server_id(<table>)
13111 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13112 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13113 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13114 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13115 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13116 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13117
13118table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13119 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13120 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13121 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13122 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13123 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13124 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13125 keyword.
13126
13127table_sess_rate(<table>)
13128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13130 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13131 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13132 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13133 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13134 keyword.
13135
13136table_trackers(<table>)
13137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13139 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13140 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13141 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13142 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13143 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13144 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13145 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13146 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13147
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013148upper
13149 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13150 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13151 type. The result is of type string.
13152
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013153url_dec
13154 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13155 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13156
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013157unset-var(<var name>)
13158 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13159 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13160 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13161 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13162 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13163 response),
13164 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13165 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13166 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13167 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13168
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013169utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13170 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13171 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13172 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13173 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13174 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13175 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13176
13177 Example :
13178
13179 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13180 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13181 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13182
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013183word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13184 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13185 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13186
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013187wt6([<avalanche>])
13188 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13189 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13190 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13191 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13192 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13193 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13194 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013195 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13196 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013197
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013198xor(<value>)
13199 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013200 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013201 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013202 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013203 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013204 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13205 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013206 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013207 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13208 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013209 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013210 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013211
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013212xxh32([<seed>])
13213 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13214 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13215 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13216 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13217 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13218 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13219 as cryptographically secure.
13220
13221xxh64([<seed>])
13222 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13223 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13224 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13225 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13226 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13227 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13228 as cryptographically secure.
13229
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013230
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132317.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232--------------------------------------------
13233
13234A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13235not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13236"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13237The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13238
13239always_false : boolean
13240 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13241 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13242
13243always_true : boolean
13244 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13245 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13246
13247avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013248 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13250 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13251 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13252 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13253 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13254 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13255 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13256 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13257 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13258 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13259 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13260 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13261 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013264 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13265 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13266 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13267 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13268 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13272 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13273 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13274 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13275 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13276 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013277
13278 Example :
13279 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13280 backend dynamic
13281 mode http
13282 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13283 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013284
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013285bin(<hexa>) : bin
13286 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13287 of the string.
13288
13289bool(<bool>) : bool
13290 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13291 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013295 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13297 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013298
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013299 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013300 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013301 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13302
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013303 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13304 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013305
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013306 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013307 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013309 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13310 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013311 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013312 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013313
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013314 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13315 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013316 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013317 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013318
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013319date([<offset>]) : integer
13320 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13321 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13322 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13323 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013324 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13325
13326 Example :
13327
13328 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13329 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013330
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013331distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13332 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13333 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13334 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13335 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13336 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13337 list of supported tokens.
13338
13339distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13340 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13341 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13342 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13343 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13344 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13345 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13346 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13347 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13348 supported tokens.
13349
13350 Example :
13351 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13352 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13353 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13354 # send large files to the big farm
13355 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13356
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013357env(<name>) : string
13358 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13359 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13360 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13361 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13362 certain way.
13363
13364 Examples :
13365 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13366 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13367
13368 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13369 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13372 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013373 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13374 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13376 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13377 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13378 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13379 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013380
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013381fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13382 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13383 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13384 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13388 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13389 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13390 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13391 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13392 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13393 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13394 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013395
13396 Example :
13397 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13398 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13399 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13400 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13401 frontend mail
13402 bind :25
13403 mode tcp
13404 maxconn 100
13405 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13406 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13407 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13408 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013409
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013410hostname : string
13411 Returns the system hostname.
13412
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013413int(<integer>) : signed integer
13414 Returns a signed integer.
13415
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013416ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13417 Returns an ipv4.
13418
13419ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13420 Returns an ipv6.
13421
13422meth(<method>) : method
13423 Returns a method.
13424
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013425nbproc : integer
13426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13427 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13428 and debugging purposes.
13429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13431 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13432 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13433 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013434 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13435 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13436 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013437
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013438proc : integer
13439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13440 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13441 debugging purposes.
13442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013444 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13445 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13446 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13448 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13449 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13450 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13451 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13452
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013453rand([<range>]) : integer
13454 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13455 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13456 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13457 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13458 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13462 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13463 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13464 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13465 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13466 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13467 methods.
13468
13469srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13470 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13471 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13472 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13473 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13474 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13475 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13476 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13477
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013478srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13480 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13481 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13482 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13483 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13484 fetch methods.
13485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13487 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13488 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013489 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013490 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13491 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13492 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13493 overloading servers).
13494
13495 Example :
13496 # Redirect to a separate back
13497 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13498 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13499 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13500
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013501stopping : boolean
13502 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13503 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13504 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13505
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013506str(<string>) : string
13507 Returns a string.
13508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013509table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13510 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13511 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13512
13513table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13514 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13515 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13516 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13517
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013518var(<var-name>) : undefined
13519 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013520 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13521 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013522 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013523 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13524 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013525 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013526 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13527 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013528 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013529 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135317.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532----------------------------------
13533
13534The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13535closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13536methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13537sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13538TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013539the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13540counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13541"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013542argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13543the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13544this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545
13546be_id : integer
13547 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13548 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13549
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013550be_name : string
13551 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13552 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554dst : ip
13555 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13556 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13557 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13558 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13559 RFC 4291.
13560
13561dst_conn : integer
13562 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13563 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13564 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13565 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13566 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13567 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13568 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13569 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013570
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013571dst_is_local : boolean
13572 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13573 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13574 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13575 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13576 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13577 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13578 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13579 it only once per connection.
13580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581dst_port : integer
13582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13583 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13584 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13585 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13586 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13587 an HTTP header.
13588
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013589fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13590 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13591 header.
13592
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013593fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13594 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13595 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13596 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13597 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13598 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13599 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13600
13601fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13602 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13603 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13604 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13605 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13606 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13607 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13608
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013609fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13610 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13611 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13612 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13613 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13614
13615fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13616 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13617 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13618 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13619 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13620
13621fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13622 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13623 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13624 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13625 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13626
13627fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13628 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13629 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13630 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13631 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13632
13633fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13634 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13635 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13636 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13637 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13638
13639fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13640 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13641 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13642 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13643 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645fe_id : integer
13646 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013647 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013648 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13649
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013650fe_name : string
13651 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13652 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13653 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13654
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013655sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013656sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13657sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13658sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013659 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13660 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13661 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13662
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013663sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013664sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13665sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13666sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013667 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13668 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13669 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13670
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013671sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013672sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13673sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13674sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013675 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13676 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013677 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13678 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13679 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013680
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013681 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013682 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13683 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013684 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13685 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13686 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013687 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13688 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013690sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013691sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13692sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13693sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013694 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13695 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13696
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013697sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013698sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13699sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13700sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013701 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13702 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13703 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13704
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013705sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013706sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13707sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13708sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013709 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13710 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13711 See also src_conn_rate.
13712
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013713sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013714sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13715sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13716sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013717 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013718 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013719
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013720sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13721sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13722sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13723sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13724 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13725 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13726
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013727sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013728sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13729sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13730sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013731 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13732 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13733 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013734 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13735 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13736 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013737
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013738sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013739sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13740sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13741sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013742 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13743 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13744 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13745
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013746sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013747sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13748sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13749sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013750 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13751 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13752 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13753 src_http_err_rate.
13754
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013755sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013756sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13757sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13758sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013759 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13760 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13761 src_http_req_cnt.
13762
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013763sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013764sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13765sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13766sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013767 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13768 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13769 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13770 src_http_req_rate.
13771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013772sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013773sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13774sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13775sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013776 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013777 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13778 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13779 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13780 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013781
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013782 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013783 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13784 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013785 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013787sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013788sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13789sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13790sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013791 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13792 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13793 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013795sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013796sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13797sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13798sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013799 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13800 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13801 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013803sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013804sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13805sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13806sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013807 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13808 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13809 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13810 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013811 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013812 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13813
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013814sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013815sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13816sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13817sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013818 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13819 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13820 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13821 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13822 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013823 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013825sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013826sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13827sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13828sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013829 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13830 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13831 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13832
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013833sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013834sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13835sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13836sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013837 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13838 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013839 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013840 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13841 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013842 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13843 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13844 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846so_id : integer
13847 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13848 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13849 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851src : ip
13852 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13853 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13854 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13855 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013856 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13857 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13858 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13859 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013860
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013861 Example:
13862 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13863 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13866 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13867 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13868 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013869 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13872 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13873 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013874 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013875 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13878 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13879 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13880 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13881 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13882 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13883 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013884
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013885 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013886 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13887 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13888 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13889 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013890 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013891 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13892 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013894src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013895 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013897 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013898 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013901 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13903 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013904 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13907 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13908 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13909 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013910 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013913 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013915 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013916 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013917
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013918src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13919 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13920 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13921 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13922 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013925 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013927 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13928 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013929 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13930 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13931 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013933src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13934 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13935 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013936 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013937 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013940src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13941 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13942 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13943 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13944 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013945 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13948 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13949 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13950 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013951 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13954 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13955 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13956 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013957 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013958 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013960src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13961 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13962 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13963 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013964 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13966 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013967
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013968 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013969 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013970 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013971 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013972
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013973src_is_local : boolean
13974 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13975 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13976 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13977 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13978 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13979 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13980 once per connection.
13981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013982src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013983 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13984 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13985 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13986 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13987 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013990 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13991 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13992 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13993 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13994 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996src_port : integer
13997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13998 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13999 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14000 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14003 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014004 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14005 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14006 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014007 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14010 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14012 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14013 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014014 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14017 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14018 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14019 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14020 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14021 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14022 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14023 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14024 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014025
14026 Example :
14027 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14028 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14029 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14030 listen ssh
14031 bind :22
14032 mode tcp
14033 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014034 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014036 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038srv_id : integer
14039 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14040 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14041 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140437.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14047closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14048when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14049usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014050future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014051
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001405251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14053 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14054 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14055 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14056 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14057 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14058
14059 Example :
14060 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14061 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14062 # the request.
14063 frontend http-in
14064 bind *:8081
14065 default_backend servers
14066 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14067 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14068
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014069ssl_bc : boolean
14070 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14071 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14072 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14073
14074ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14075 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14076 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14077
14078ssl_bc_cipher : string
14079 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14080 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14081
14082ssl_bc_protocol : string
14083 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14084 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14085
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014086ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014087 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014088 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14089 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014090
14091ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14092 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14093 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14094 if session was reused or not.
14095
14096ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14097 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14098 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14101 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14102 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14103 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14104 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14105 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14108 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14109 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14110 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14111 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014112
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014113ssl_c_der : binary
14114 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14115 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14116 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118ssl_c_err : integer
14119 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14120 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14121 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14122 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14123 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14126 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14127 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14128 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14129 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14130 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14131 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14132 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14133 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135ssl_c_key_alg : string
14136 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14137 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14138 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014140ssl_c_notafter : string
14141 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14142 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14143 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145ssl_c_notbefore : string
14146 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14147 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14148 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14151 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14152 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14153 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14154 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14155 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14156 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14157 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14158 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160ssl_c_serial : binary
14161 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14162 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14163 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14166 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14167 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14168 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014169 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14170 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14171
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014172 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014173 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14176 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14177 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14178 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014180ssl_c_used : boolean
14181 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14182 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184ssl_c_verify : integer
14185 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14186 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14187 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14188 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014190ssl_c_version : integer
14191 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14192 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014193
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014194ssl_f_der : binary
14195 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14196 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14197 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14201 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14202 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14206 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14207 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209ssl_f_key_alg : string
14210 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14211 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14212 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214ssl_f_notafter : string
14215 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14216 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14217 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219ssl_f_notbefore : string
14220 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14222 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14225 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14226 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14227 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14228 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14229 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14230 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14231 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14232 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234ssl_f_serial : binary
14235 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14236 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14237 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014238
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014239ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14240 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14241 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14242 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14245 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14246 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14247 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249ssl_f_version : integer
14250 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14251 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14252
14253ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014254 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14255 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14256 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258 Example :
14259 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14260 listen http-https
14261 bind :80
14262 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14263 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14264
14265ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14266 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14267 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14268
14269ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014270 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014271 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14272 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14273 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14274 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14275 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14276 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14277 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14278 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280ssl_fc_cipher : string
14281 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14282 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014283
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014284ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14285 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14286 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014287 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014288
14289ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14290 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14291 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014292 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014293
14294ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14295 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14296 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14297 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014298 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14299 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014300
14301ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14302 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14303 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014304 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014307 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14308 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014309 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14310 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14311 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14312 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014313
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014314ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14315 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14316 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14317 wait until the handshake happened.
14318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14320 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014321 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14322 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14323 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14324 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014325
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014326ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014327 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14328 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014331 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14333 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14334 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14335 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14336 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14337 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14338 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340ssl_fc_protocol : string
14341 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14342 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014343
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014344ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014345 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014346 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14347 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14350 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14351 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14352 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14353 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355ssl_fc_sni : string
14356 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14357 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14358 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14359 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14360 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14361
14362 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14363 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14364 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014365 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14366 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14370 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14373 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14374 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014375
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014376
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143777.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14381sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14382only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14383For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14384be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14385can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14386sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14387for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14388content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014390payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14391 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14392 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14393 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14396 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14397 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14398 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014399
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014400req.hdrs : string
14401 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14402 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14403 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14404 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14405
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014406req.hdrs_bin : binary
14407 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14408 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14409 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14410 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14411 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14412 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14413
14414 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14415
14416 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14417 str: <int:length><bytes>
14418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419req.len : integer
14420req_len : integer (deprecated)
14421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14422 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14423 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14424 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14425 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14426 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14427 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14428 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14431 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014432 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14433 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14434 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14435 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437 ACL alternatives :
14438 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14441 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14442 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14443 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14444 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446 ACL alternatives :
14447 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451req.proto_http : boolean
14452req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14453 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14454 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14455 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14456 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14457 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14458 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14459 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461 Example:
14462 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14463 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14464 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014465 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014467req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14468rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14469 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14470 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14471 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14472 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14473 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14474 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14475 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14478 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14479 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14480 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14481 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14482 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484 ACL derivatives :
14485 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014487 Example :
14488 listen tse-farm
14489 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14490 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14491 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14492 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14493 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14494 persist rdp-cookie
14495 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14496 # This is only useful makes sense if
14497 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14498 stick-table type string size 204800
14499 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14500 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14501 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14504 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14507rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14508 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14509 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14510 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14511 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513 ACL derivatives :
14514 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014515
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014516req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14517 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14518 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014519 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14520 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14521 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14522 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14523 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14526req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14527 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14528 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14529 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14530 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14531 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14532 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14533 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535req.ssl_sni : string
14536req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14537 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14538 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14539 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14540 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14541 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14542 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14543 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14544 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14545 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14546 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14547 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14548 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 ACL derivatives :
14551 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553 Examples :
14554 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14555 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14556 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14557 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14558 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014559
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014560req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14561 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14562 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14563 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14564 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14565 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14566 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14567 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14568 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14569 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571req.ssl_ver : integer
14572req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14573 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14574 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14575 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14576 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14577 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14578 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14579 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14580 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14581 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 ACL derivatives :
14584 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014585
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014586res.len : integer
14587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14588 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14589 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14590 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14591 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14592 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14593 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14594 content inspection.
14595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14597 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014598 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14599 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14600 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14601 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14604 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14605 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14606 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14607 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014610
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014611res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14612rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14613 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14614 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14615 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14616 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14617 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14618 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14619 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621wait_end : boolean
14622 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14623 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14624 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14625 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14626 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14627 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14628 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14629 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631 Examples :
14632 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14633 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14634 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14637 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14638 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14639 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14640 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14641 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14642 tcp-request content reject
14643
14644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646--------------------------------------
14647
14648It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14649This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14650data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14651its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14652HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14653content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14654to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14655more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14656response are indexed.
14657
14658base : string
14659 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14660 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14661 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14662 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14663 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14664 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14665 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14666 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14667
14668 ACL derivatives :
14669 base : exact string match
14670 base_beg : prefix match
14671 base_dir : subdir match
14672 base_dom : domain match
14673 base_end : suffix match
14674 base_len : length match
14675 base_reg : regex match
14676 base_sub : substring match
14677
14678base32 : integer
14679 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14680 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14681 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014682 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14683 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14684 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685
14686base32+src : binary
14687 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14688 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14689 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14690 per-URL counters.
14691
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014692capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14693 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14694 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14695 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14696
14697capture.req.method : string
14698 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14699 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14700 because it's allocated.
14701
14702capture.req.uri : string
14703 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14704 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14705 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14706 allocated.
14707
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014708capture.req.ver : string
14709 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14710 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14711 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14712
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014713capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14714 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14715 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14716 The first entry is an index of 0.
14717 See also: "capture response header"
14718
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014719capture.res.ver : string
14720 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14721 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14722 persistent flag.
14723
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014724req.body : binary
14725 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14726 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14727 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14728 the first chunk is analyzed.
14729
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014730req.body_param([<name>) : string
14731 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14732 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14733 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14734 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14735 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14736 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14737 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14738 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14739 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14740 given.
14741
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014742req.body_len : integer
14743 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14744 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14745 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14746 "option http-buffer-request".
14747
14748req.body_size : integer
14749 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14750 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14751 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14752 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14753 "option http-buffer-request".
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755req.cook([<name>]) : string
14756cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14757 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14758 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14759 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14760 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14761 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14762 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14763 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14764 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14765
14766 ACL derivatives :
14767 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14768 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14769 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14770 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14771 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14772 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14773 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14774 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014776req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14777cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14778 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14779 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14782cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14783 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14784 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14785 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14786 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14789 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14790 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14791 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14792 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014793 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14795 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14796 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14797 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14800 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14801 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14802 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14803 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014804 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014806req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14807 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14808 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14809 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14810 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14811 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14812 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14813 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14814 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14817 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14818 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14819 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14820 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14823 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14824 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14825 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14826 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14827 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14828 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14829 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14830 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014831 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14833 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835 ACL derivatives :
14836 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14837 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14838 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14839 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14840 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14841 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14842 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14843 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14844
14845req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14846hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14847 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14848 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14849 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14850 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14851 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14852 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14853 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14854 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14855 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14856
14857req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14858hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14859 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14860 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14861 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14862 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14863 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14864 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14865 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14866 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14867
14868req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14869hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14871 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14872 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14873 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14874 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14875 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14876 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14877
14878http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14879 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14880 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14881 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14882 basic auth is supported.
14883
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014884http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14885 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14886 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14887 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14888 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14890 basic auth is supported.
14891
14892 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014893 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14894 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14895 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14896 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897
14898http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014899 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14900 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014901 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14902 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904method : integer + string
14905 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14906 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14907 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14908 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14909 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14910 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14911 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913 ACL derivatives :
14914 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 Example :
14917 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14918 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14919 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921path : string
14922 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14923 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14924 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14925 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14926 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14927 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14928 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930 ACL derivatives :
14931 path : exact string match
14932 path_beg : prefix match
14933 path_dir : subdir match
14934 path_dom : domain match
14935 path_end : suffix match
14936 path_len : length match
14937 path_reg : regex match
14938 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014939
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014940query : string
14941 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14942 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14943 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14944 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014945 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014946 which stops before the question mark.
14947
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014948req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14949 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14950 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14951 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14952 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954req.ver : string
14955req_ver : string (deprecated)
14956 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14957 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14958 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960 ACL derivatives :
14961 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963res.comp : boolean
14964 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14965 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14966 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968res.comp_algo : string
14969 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14970 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14971 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973res.cook([<name>]) : string
14974scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14975 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14976 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14977 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979 ACL derivatives :
14980 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14983scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14984 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14985 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14986 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14989scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14990 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14991 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14992 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014994res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14996 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14997 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14998 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14999 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15000 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15001 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15002 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15003 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15006 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15007 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15008 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15009 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15010 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15013shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15014 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15015 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15016 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15017 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15018 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15019 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15020 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15021 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023 ACL derivatives :
15024 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15025 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15026 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15027 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15028 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15029 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15030 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15031 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15032
15033res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15034shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15035 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15036 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15037 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15038 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15039 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15042shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15043 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15044 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15045 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15046 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15047 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15048 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015049
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015050res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15051 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15052 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15053 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15054 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15057shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15058 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15059 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15060 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15061 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15062 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15063 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065res.ver : string
15066resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15067 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15068 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070 ACL derivatives :
15071 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15074 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15075 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015076 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15080 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082status : integer
15083 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15084 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15085 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015086
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015087unique-id : string
15088 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15089 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15090 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15091 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15092 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15093 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095url : string
15096 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15097 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15098 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15099 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15100 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15101 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15102 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 ACL derivatives :
15105 url : exact string match
15106 url_beg : prefix match
15107 url_dir : subdir match
15108 url_dom : domain match
15109 url_end : suffix match
15110 url_len : length match
15111 url_reg : regex match
15112 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114url_ip : ip
15115 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15116 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15117 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15118 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15119 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15120 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15121 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123url_port : integer
15124 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15125 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15126 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15127 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015128
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015129urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15130url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15132 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015133 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15134 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15135 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15136 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015137 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15138 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015139 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15140 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142 ACL derivatives :
15143 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15144 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15145 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15146 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15147 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15148 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15149 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15150 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015151
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153 Example :
15154 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15155 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15156 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15157 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015158
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015159urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15161 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15162 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015163
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015164url32 : integer
15165 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15166 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15167 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15168 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15169 is an unsigned integer.
15170
15171url32+src : binary
15172 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15173 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15174 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15175
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015178---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015180Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15181every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015182order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015184ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15185---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015187HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015188HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15189HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015190HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15191HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15192HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15193HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15194LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015195METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015196METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015197METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15198METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15199METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15200METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015201METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015202METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015203RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015204REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015205TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015206WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15207---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015208
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152108. Logging
15211----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015212
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015213One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15214provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15215very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15216provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15217state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015218to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015219headers.
15220
15221In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15222about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15223send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15224
15225 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15226 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15227 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15228 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15229 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015230 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15231 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015232
15233The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15234allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15235as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15236while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15237real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15238delay.
15239
15240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152418.1. Log levels
15242---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015243
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015244TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015245source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015246HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15247in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15248track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15249syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15250about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015251
15252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152538.2. Log formats
15254----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015255
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015256HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015257and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15258slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15259options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015260
15261 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15262 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15263 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15264 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15265 extents.
15266
15267 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15268 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15269 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15270 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15271 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15272
15273 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15274 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15275 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15276 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15277 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15278
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015279 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15280 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15281 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15282 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15283
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015284 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15287specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15288field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15289servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15290always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15291identifier.
15292
15293Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15294 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15295 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15296 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15297 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15298
15299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153008.2.1. Default log format
15301-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015302
15303This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15304as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15305format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15306
15307 Example :
15308 listen www
15309 mode http
15310 log global
15311 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15312
15313 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15314 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15315 (www/HTTP)
15316
15317 Field Format Extract from the example above
15318 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15319 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15320 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15321 4 'to' to
15322 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15323 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15324
15325Detailed fields description :
15326 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15327 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15328 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15329 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15330 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15331 and processed the connection.
15332 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15333
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015334In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15335"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15336connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015338It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15339will eventually disappear.
15340
15341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153428.2.2. TCP log format
15343---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015344
15345The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15346is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15347information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15348counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15349emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15350environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15351the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15352sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015353specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15354not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15355fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15356marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015357
15358 Example :
15359 frontend fnt
15360 mode tcp
15361 option tcplog
15362 log global
15363 default_backend bck
15364
15365 backend bck
15366 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15367
15368 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15369 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15370 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15371
15372 Field Format Extract from the example above
15373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15374 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15375 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15376 4 frontend_name fnt
15377 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15378 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15379 7 bytes_read* 212
15380 8 termination_state --
15381 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15382 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15383
15384Detailed fields description :
15385 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015386 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15387 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15388 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015389 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15390 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15391 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015392
15393 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015394 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15395 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15396 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015397
15398 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15399 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15400 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15401 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15402
15403 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15404 and processed the connection.
15405
15406 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15407 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15408 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15409 applications.
15410
15411 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15412 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15413 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15414 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15415 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15416
15417 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15418 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15419 See "Timers" below for more details.
15420
15421 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15422 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15423 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15424 "Timers" below for more details.
15425
15426 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015427 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015428 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15429 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15430 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15431 details.
15432
15433 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15434 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15435 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15436 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15437 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15438
15439 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15440 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15441 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15442 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15443 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15444 for more details.
15445
15446 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015447 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015448 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15449 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15450 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015451 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015452
15453 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15454 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15455 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15456 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15457 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15458 caused by a denial of service attack.
15459
15460 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15461 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15462 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15463 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15464 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15465 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15466 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15467 denial of service attack.
15468
15469 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15470 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15471 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15472 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15473 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15474 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15475 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15476 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15477 be processed than on other servers.
15478
15479 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15480 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15481 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15482 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15483 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15484 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15485 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15486 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15487 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15488 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15489 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15490 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15491 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15492
15493 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15494 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15495 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15496 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15497 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15498 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15499 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15500 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15501
15502 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15503 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15504 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15505 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15506 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15507 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15508 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15509 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15510 occurs.
15511
15512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155138.2.3. HTTP log format
15514----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015515
15516The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15517is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15518the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15519are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15520emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15521generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15522"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15523which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015524frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15525is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015526
15527Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15528slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15529with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15530
15531 Example :
15532 frontend http-in
15533 mode http
15534 option httplog
15535 log global
15536 default_backend bck
15537
15538 backend static
15539 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15540
15541 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15542 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15543 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015544 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015545
15546 Field Format Extract from the example above
15547 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15548 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015549 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015550 4 frontend_name http-in
15551 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015552 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015553 7 status_code 200
15554 8 bytes_read* 2750
15555 9 captured_request_cookie -
15556 10 captured_response_cookie -
15557 11 termination_state ----
15558 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15559 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15560 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15561 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15562 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015563
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015564Detailed fields description :
15565 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015566 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15567 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15568 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015569 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15570 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15571 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015572
15573 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015574 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15575 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15576 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015577
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015578 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15579 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015580
15581 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15582 and processed the connection.
15583
15584 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15585 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15586 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15587
15588 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15589 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15590 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15591 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15592 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15593 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15594
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015595 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15596 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15597 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15598 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15599 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15600 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15601 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015602
15603 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15604 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15605 See "Timers" below for more details.
15606
15607 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15608 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15609 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15610 below for more details.
15611
15612 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15613 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15614 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15615 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15616 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15617 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15618 for more details.
15619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015620 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15621 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15622 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15623 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15624 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15625 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15626 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15627 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015628
15629 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15630 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15631 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15632
15633 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15634 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15635 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15636 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15637 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15638 overflowing.
15639
15640 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15641 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15642 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15643 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15644 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15645 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15646 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15647 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15648
15649 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15650 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15651 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15652 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15653 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15654 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15655 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15656 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15657
15658 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15659 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15660 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15661 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15662 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15663 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15664 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15665
15666 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015667 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015668 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15669 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15670 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015671 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015672 system.
15673
15674 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15675 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15676 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15677 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15678 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15679 caused by a denial of service attack.
15680
15681 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15682 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15683 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15684 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15685 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15686 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15687 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15688 denial of service attack.
15689
15690 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15691 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15692 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15693 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15694 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15695 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15696 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15697 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15698 processed than on other servers.
15699
15700 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15701 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15702 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15703 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15704 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15705 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15706 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15707 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15708 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15709 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15710 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15711 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15712 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15713
15714 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15715 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15716 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15717 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15718 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15719 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15720 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15721 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15722
15723 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15724 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15725 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15726 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15727 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15728 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15729 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15730 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15731 occurs.
15732
15733 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15734 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15735 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15736 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15737 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15738 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15739 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15740 cookies" below for more details.
15741
15742 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15743 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15744 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15745 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15746 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15747 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15748 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15749 and cookies" below for more details.
15750
15751 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15752 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15753 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15754 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15755 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15756 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15757 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15758 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15759
15760
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200157618.2.4. Custom log format
15762------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015763
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015764The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015765mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015766
15767HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15768Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15769separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15770prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15771
15772Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15773variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015774("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015775
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015776If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015777as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015778less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15779the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15780
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015781Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015782In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015783in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015784
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015785Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15786'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15787https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15788such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15789
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015790Flags are :
15791 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015792 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015793 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15794 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015795
15796 Example:
15797
15798 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15799 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15800
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015801 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15802
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015803At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15804
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015805 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15806 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015807
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015808the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015809
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015810 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15811 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15812 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015813
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015814and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15815
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015816 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15817 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015818
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015819Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15820
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015821 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015822 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015823 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15824 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15825 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015826 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15827 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15828 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015829 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015830 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15831 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015832 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015833 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15834 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015835 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015836 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015837 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015838 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015839 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015840 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015841 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015842 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15843 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15844 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15845 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15846 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015847 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015848 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15849 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015850 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015851 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15852 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015853 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15854 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15855 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015856 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015857 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15858 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015859 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015860 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15861 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15862 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015863 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015864 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015865 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15866 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15867 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15868 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015869 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015870 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015871 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015872 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015873 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015874 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015875 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15876 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15877 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015878 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015879 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15880 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015881 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015882 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15883 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15884 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015885 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015886 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015887 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015888
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015889 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015890
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015891
158928.2.5. Error log format
15893-----------------------
15894
15895When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15896protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15897By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15898"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15899will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15900logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15901
15902The format looks like this :
15903
15904 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15905 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15906 Connection error during SSL handshake
15907
15908 Field Format Extract from the example above
15909 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15910 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15911 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15912 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15913 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15914
15915These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15916failures.
15917
15918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159198.3. Advanced logging options
15920-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015921
15922Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15923just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15924options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15925for more information about their usage.
15926
15927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15929------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930
15931It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15932haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15933commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15934monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15935ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15936
15937 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15938 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15939 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15940 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15941
15942 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15943 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15944 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015945 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015946 such as other load-balancers.
15947
15948 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15949 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15950 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15951
15952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15954----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015955
15956The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15957what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15958or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15959"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15960just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15961log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15962after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15963is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15964with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15965with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15966
15967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15969------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015970
15971Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15972for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15973"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15974retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15975raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15976a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15977file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15978you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15979"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15980
15981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15983--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015984
15985Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15986multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15987them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15988"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15989logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15990error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15991and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15992too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15993useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15994alternative.
15995
15996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159978.4. Timing events
15998------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015999
16000Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16001reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16002the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16003frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016004mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16005addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16006
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016007Timings events in HTTP mode:
16008
16009 first request 2nd request
16010 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16011 t tr t tr ...
16012 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16013 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16014 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16015 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16016 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16017
16018Timings events in TCP mode:
16019
16020 TCP session
16021 |<----------------->|
16022 t t
16023 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16024 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16025 |<------ Tt ------->|
16026
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016027 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16028 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16029 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16030 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16031 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16032 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16033 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016034
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016035 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16036 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16037 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16038 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16039 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16040 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16041 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16042 nothing was received on the connection.
16043
16044 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16045 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16046 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16047 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16048 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16049 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16050 request typed by hand during a test.
16051
16052 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16053 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16054 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16055 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16056 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16057 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16058 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016059
16060 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16061 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16062 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16063 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16064 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16065
16066 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16067 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16068 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16069 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16070 connection never established.
16071
16072 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16073 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16074 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16075 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16076 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16077 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16078 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16079 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16080 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16081 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16082 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016084 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16085 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16086 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16087 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16088 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16089 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16090
16091 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16092
16093 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16094 "Ta" can never be negative.
16095
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016096 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16097 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016098 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16099 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016100 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016101
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016102 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016103
16104 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016105 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16106 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016107
16108These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16109protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16110that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016111due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16112"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16113that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016114
16115Most common cases :
16116
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016117 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16118 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16119 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16120 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16121 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16122 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16123 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16124 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16125 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16126 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16127 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016128 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016129
16130 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16131 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16132 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16133 of ms on remote networks.
16134
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016135 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16136 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16137 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016139 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16140 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16141 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16142 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16143 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16144 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16145 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16146 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16147 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148
16149Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016151 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016152 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016153 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016155 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016156 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16157 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16158
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016159 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016160 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16161 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16162 flags.
16163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016164 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16165 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016166 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16167 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16168 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16169 the client connection was maintained open.
16170
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016171 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016172 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016173 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016174 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16175
16176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161778.5. Session state at disconnection
16178-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016179
16180TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16181"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
161822-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16183each of which has a special meaning :
16184
16185 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16186 session to terminate :
16187
16188 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16189
16190 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16191 server explicitly refused it.
16192
16193 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16194 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16195 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16196 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016197 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16198
16199 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16200 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016201
16202 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16203 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16204 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16205 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16206 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16207
16208 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16209 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16210 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16211 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16212 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16213
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016214 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16215 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16216
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016217 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16218 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16219 backup connections when going up.
16220
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016221 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16224 send or receive data.
16225
16226 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16227 send or receive data.
16228
16229 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16230 with nothing left in the buffers.
16231
16232 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16233
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016234 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016235 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16236
16237 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16238 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16239 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16240 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16241 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16242
16243 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16244 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16245
16246 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16247 server (HTTP only).
16248
16249 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16250
16251 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16252 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16253 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16254
16255 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16256 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16257 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16258
16259 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16260
16261 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16262 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16263
16264 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16265 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16266 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16267
16268 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16269 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016270 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16271 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016272
16273 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16274 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16275 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16276 another server.
16277
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016278 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016279 server.
16280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016281 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16282 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16283 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16284 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16285
16286 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16287 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16288 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16289 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16290
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016291 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16292 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16293 "use-server" rule).
16294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016295 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16296
16297 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16298 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16299
16300 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16301
16302 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16303 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16304 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16305
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016306 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16307 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016308 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016309 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16310 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16311
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016312 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16313
16314 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16315 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16316
16317 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16318
16319 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16320
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016321The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16322was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016323helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16324starvation, attacks, etc...
16325
16326The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16327alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16328easier finding and understanding.
16329
16330 Flags Reason
16331
16332 -- Normal termination.
16333
16334 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16335 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16336 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16337 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16338
16339 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16340 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16341 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16342 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16343 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16344 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016345
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16347 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016348 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016349
16350 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16351 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16352 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16353
16354 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16355 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16356 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16357 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16358 the server takes too long to respond.
16359
16360 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16361 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16362 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16363 long a time to respond.
16364
16365 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16366 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16367 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16368 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016369 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16370 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016371
16372 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16373 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16374 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16375 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16376 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016377 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016378 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16379 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16380 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16381 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16382 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16383 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16384 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16385 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16386 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16387 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16388 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16389 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016390
16391 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16392 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016393 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16394 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16395 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16396 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016397
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016398 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16399 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016401 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016402 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16403 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16404 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16405 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16406 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16407
16408 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16409 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16410 503 or 504 here.
16411
16412 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16413 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16414 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16415 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16416 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16417
16418 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16419 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016420 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016421 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16422 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16423
16424 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16425 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16426 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16427 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16428 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16429 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16430 between haproxy and the server.
16431
16432 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16433 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16434 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16435 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16436 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16437 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16438 solution is to fix the application.
16439
16440 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16441 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16442 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16443 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16444 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16445 external attacks.
16446
16447 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16448 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016449 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016450 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16451 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16452
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016453 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16454 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16455 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016456 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16457 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016459 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16460 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16461 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16462 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016463 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16464 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16465 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16466 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16467 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468
16469 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16470 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16471 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16472 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16473
16474 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16475 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16476 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16477 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16478
16479 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16480 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16481 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16482 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16483
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016484The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16485persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16486important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16487re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16488
16489 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16490
16491 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16492 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16493 set on a GET request.
16494
16495 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16496 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016497 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016498 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16499
16500 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16501 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16502 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16503
16504 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16505 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16506 already got a cookie.
16507
16508 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16509 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16510 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16511 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16512 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16513
16514 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16515 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16516 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16517
16518 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16519 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16520 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16521
16522 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16523 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16524
16525 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16526 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16527 then advertised in the response.
16528
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165308.6. Non-printable characters
16531-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016532
16533In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16534consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16535converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16536prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16537being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16538escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16539is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16540'}' when logging headers.
16541
16542Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16543issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16544containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16545
16546Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16547the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16548performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16549
16550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165518.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16552---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016553
16554Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16555achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016556section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016557cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16558the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16559the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016561not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16562user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16563a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16564wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16565
16566 Examples :
16567 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16568 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16569
16570 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16571 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16572
16573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165748.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16575---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016576
16577Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16578proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16579the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16580server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16581
16582Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16583response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016584section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016585
16586It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016587time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16588appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016589are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16590and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16591follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16592request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16593in the logs.
16594
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016595As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16596frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16597an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16598
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016599 Example :
16600 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16601 listen proxy-out
16602 mode http
16603 option httplog
16604 option logasap
16605 log global
16606 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16607
16608 # log the name of the virtual server
16609 capture request header Host len 20
16610
16611 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16612 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16613
16614 # log the beginning of the referrer
16615 capture request header Referer len 20
16616
16617 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16618 capture response header Server len 20
16619
16620 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16621 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16622
16623 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16624 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16625
16626 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16627 capture response header Via len 20
16628
16629 # log the URL location during a redirection
16630 capture response header Location len 20
16631
16632 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16633 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16634 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16635 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16636 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16637
16638 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16639 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16640 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16641 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016642 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016643
16644 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16645 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16646 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16647 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16648 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016649 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016650
16651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166528.9. Examples of logs
16653---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16656them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16657reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16658
16659 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16660 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16661 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16662
16663 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16664 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16665
16666 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16667 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16668 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16669
16670 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16671 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16672
16673 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16674 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16675 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16676
16677 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016678 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016679 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16680 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16681
16682 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16683 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16684 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16685
16686 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16687 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016688 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16690 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16691 to return the 502 and not the server.
16692
16693 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016694 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016695
16696 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16697 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16698 Nothing was sent to any server.
16699
16700 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16701 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16702
16703 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16704 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16705 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16706 send a 408 return code to the client.
16707
16708 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16709 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16710
16711 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16712 5 seconds ("c----").
16713
16714 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16715 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016716 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717
16718 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016719 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16721 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16722 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16723 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16724 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016725
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016726
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167279. Supported filters
16728--------------------
16729
16730Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16731accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16732unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16733
16734See also : "filter"
16735
167369.1. Trace
16737----------
16738
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016739filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016740
16741 Arguments:
16742 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16743 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16744
16745 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16746 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16747 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16748 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16749
16750 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16751 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16752 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16753 amount of the parsed data.
16754
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016755 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16756
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016757This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16758callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16759information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16760filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16761
16762Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16763tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16764a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16765
16766
167679.2. HTTP compression
16768---------------------
16769
16770filter compression
16771
16772The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16773keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16774when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16775use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16776used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16777filters evaluation order.
16778
16779See also : "compression"
16780
16781
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200167829.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16783--------------------------------------------
16784
16785filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16786
16787 Arguments :
16788
16789 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16790 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16791 parsed.
16792
16793 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16794 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16795 part must be placed in its own scope.
16796
16797The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16798external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16799streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16800exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16801also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16802
16803SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16804the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16805
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016806For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016807"doc/SPOE.txt".
16808
16809Important note:
16810 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16811 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016813/*
16814 * Local variables:
16815 * fill-column: 79
16816 * End:
16817 */